4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
7 @include org-version.inc
9 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
10 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
11 @set txicodequoteundirected
12 @set txicodequotebacktick
14 @c Version and Contact Info
15 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
16 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
17 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
19 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
24 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
26 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
27 @c =======================================
29 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
30 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
34 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
36 @c orgkey{key} A key item
37 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
38 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
39 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
40 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
41 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
42 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
43 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
45 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
46 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
48 @c a key but no command
60 @c one key with a command
61 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
62 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
67 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
70 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
79 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
80 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
81 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
86 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
89 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
98 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
99 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
100 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
104 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
107 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
115 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
116 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
117 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
122 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
125 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
134 @c two keys with one command
135 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
136 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
142 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
145 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
151 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
155 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
157 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
158 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
159 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
166 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
170 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
181 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
182 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
183 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
189 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
192 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
198 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
202 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
203 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
204 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
210 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
213 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
219 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
223 @c two keys with two commands
224 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
225 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
226 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
233 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
234 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
237 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
238 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
248 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
251 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
254 @c Subheadings inside a table.
255 @macro tsubheading{text}
257 @subsubheading \text\
265 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
267 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
270 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
271 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
272 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
273 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
274 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
275 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
277 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
278 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
279 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
281 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
282 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
283 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
284 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
288 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
290 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
294 @title The Org Manual
296 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
297 @author by Carsten Dominik
298 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
300 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
302 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
306 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
310 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
317 * Introduction:: Getting started
318 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
319 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
320 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
321 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
322 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
323 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
324 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
325 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
326 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
327 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
328 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
329 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
330 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
331 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
332 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
333 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
334 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
335 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
336 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
337 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
338 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
341 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
345 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
346 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
347 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
348 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
349 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
353 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
354 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
355 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
356 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
357 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
358 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
359 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
360 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
361 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
362 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
363 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
367 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
368 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
369 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
370 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
371 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
372 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
376 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
377 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
378 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
379 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
380 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
381 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
382 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
383 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
384 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
388 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
389 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
390 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
391 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
392 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
393 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
394 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
395 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
399 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
403 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
404 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
405 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
406 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
407 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
408 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
410 Extended use of TODO keywords
412 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
413 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
414 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
415 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
416 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
417 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
418 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
422 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
423 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
424 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
428 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
429 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
430 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
432 Properties and columns
434 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
435 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
436 * Property searches:: Matching property values
437 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
438 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
439 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
443 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
444 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
445 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
449 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
450 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
454 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
455 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
456 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
457 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
458 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
459 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
460 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
464 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
465 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
467 Deadlines and scheduling
469 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
470 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
474 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
475 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
476 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
478 Capture - Refile - Archive
480 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
481 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
482 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
483 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
484 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
485 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
489 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
490 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
491 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
495 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
496 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
500 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
501 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
505 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
506 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
507 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
508 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
509 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
510 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
511 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
512 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
514 The built-in agenda views
516 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
517 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
518 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
519 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
520 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
521 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
523 Presentation and sorting
525 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
526 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
527 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
531 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
532 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
533 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
535 Markup for rich export
537 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
538 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
539 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
540 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
541 * Index entries:: Making an index
542 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
543 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
545 Structural markup elements
547 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
548 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
549 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
550 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
552 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
553 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
554 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
555 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
556 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
560 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
561 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
562 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
563 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
564 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
568 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
569 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
570 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
571 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
572 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
573 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
574 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
575 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
576 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
577 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
578 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
579 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
583 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
584 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
585 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
586 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
587 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
588 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
589 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
590 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
591 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
592 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
594 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
596 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
597 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
598 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
599 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
600 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
601 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
605 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
606 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
607 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
608 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
609 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
610 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
612 OpenDocument Text export
614 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
615 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
616 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
617 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
618 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
619 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
620 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
621 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
622 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
623 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
624 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
626 Math formatting in ODT export
628 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
629 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
631 Advanced topics in ODT export
633 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
634 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
635 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
636 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
637 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
641 * Configuration:: Defining projects
642 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
643 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
644 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
648 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
649 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
650 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
651 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
652 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
653 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
654 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
655 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
659 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
660 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
662 Working with source code
664 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
665 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
666 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
667 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
668 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
669 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
670 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
671 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
672 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
673 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
674 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
675 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
679 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
680 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
682 Using header arguments
684 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
685 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
686 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
687 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
688 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
689 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
691 Specific header arguments
693 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
694 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
695 be collected and handled
696 * file:: Specify a path for file output
697 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
698 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
699 directory for code block execution
700 * exports:: Export code and/or results
701 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
702 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
703 files during tangling
704 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
706 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
708 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
709 expansion during tangling
710 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
711 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
712 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
713 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
714 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
715 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
716 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
717 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
718 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
719 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
720 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
721 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
725 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
726 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
727 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
728 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
729 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
730 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
731 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
732 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
733 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
734 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
735 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
737 Interaction with other packages
739 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
740 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
744 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
745 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
746 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
747 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
748 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
749 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
750 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
751 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
752 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
753 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
755 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
757 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
758 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
759 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
760 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
764 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
765 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
766 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
771 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
772 @chapter Introduction
776 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
777 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
778 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
779 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
780 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
783 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
787 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
788 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
790 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
791 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
792 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
793 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
794 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
795 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
796 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
797 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
798 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
799 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
800 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
801 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
802 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
805 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
806 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
807 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
809 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
810 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
811 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
813 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
814 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
815 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
816 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
817 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
818 the minor Orgstruct mode.
820 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
821 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
822 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
823 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
827 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
828 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
829 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
830 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
831 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
832 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
833 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
834 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
835 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
840 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
841 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
842 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
843 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
845 @cindex print edition
846 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
847 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
853 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
854 @section Installation
858 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
859 distribution, GNU ELPA or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go
860 directly to @ref{Activation}. To see what version of Org (if any) is part of
861 your Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x org-version} (if your Emacs
862 distribution does not come with Org, this function will not be defined).}
864 If you have downloaded Org from the Web as a distribution @file{.zip} or
865 @file{.tar} archive, you must take the following steps to install it:
868 @item Unpack the distribution archive.
869 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org directory.
870 @item Run @code{make help}
871 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
872 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
873 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed.
874 @item Run @code{make config}
875 to check the configuration.
876 @item Run @code{make install} or @code{sudo make install}
877 to build and install Org mode on your system. If you use a local Git
878 repository, preferrably us @code{make update2} or, if you want to run the
879 complete test suite before installation, @code{make up2}.
882 If you use a cloned Git repository, then the procedure is slightly different:
885 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
886 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
887 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
888 @item Run @code{make help}
889 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
890 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
891 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed.
892 @item Run @code{make config}
893 to check the configuration.
894 @item Run @code{make update2} or @code{make up2}
895 to update the Git repository and build and install Org mode. The latter
896 invocation runs the complete test suite before installation and installs only
897 if the build passes all tests.
900 If you don't have access to the system-wide directories and you don't want to
901 install somewhere into your home directory, you can run Org directly from the
902 distribution directory or Org repository by compiling Org mode in place:
905 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
906 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
907 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
908 @item Run @code{make compile}
911 Last but not least you can also run Org mode directly from an Org repository
912 without any compilation. Simply replace the last step in the recipe above
913 with @code{make uncompiled}.
915 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
918 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
922 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
923 step for this directory:
926 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp")
929 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
930 @file{install-info} program. The Info documentation is installed together
931 with the rest of Org mode. If you don't install Org mode, it is possible to
932 install the Info documentation seperately (you need to have
933 install-info@footnote{The output from install-info (if any) is system
934 dependent. In particular Debian and its derivatives use two different
935 versions of install-info and you may see the message:
938 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
939 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
942 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}
949 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
950 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
951 when Org mode starts.
953 (require 'org-install)
956 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
959 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
963 @cindex global key bindings
964 @cindex key bindings, global
966 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
967 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
969 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
971 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
972 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
973 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
975 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
976 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
977 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
978 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
981 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
982 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
983 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
984 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
987 @cindex Org mode, turning on
988 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
989 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
993 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
996 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
997 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
998 the file's name is. See also the variable
999 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
1001 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
1002 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
1003 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
1004 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
1006 (transient-mark-mode 1)
1008 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
1009 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
1010 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
1012 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1019 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1020 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1021 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1022 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1023 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1024 moderators have to do.}.
1026 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1027 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1028 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1029 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1030 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1031 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1032 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1034 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1036 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1037 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1038 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1040 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1041 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1042 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1043 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1044 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1047 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1050 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1051 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as @code{emacs
1052 -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as shown below.
1055 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1057 ;; activate debugging
1058 (setq debug-on-error t
1062 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1063 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1064 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp"))
1067 (require 'org-install)
1070 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1071 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1075 @item What exactly did you do?
1076 @item What did you expect to happen?
1077 @item What happened instead?
1079 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1081 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1083 @cindex backtrace of an error
1084 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1085 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1086 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1087 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1088 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1092 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1093 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1096 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1099 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1102 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1103 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1105 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1106 document the steps you take.
1108 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1109 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1110 attach it to your bug report.
1113 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1114 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1116 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1117 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1122 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1126 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1127 meaning are written with all capitals.
1130 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1131 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1134 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1135 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1136 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1137 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1138 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1141 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing a
1142 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1143 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1144 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1145 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1146 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1147 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1148 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1150 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1151 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1153 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1154 @chapter Document structure
1155 @cindex document structure
1156 @cindex structure of document
1158 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1159 edit the structure of the document.
1162 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1163 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1164 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1165 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1166 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1167 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1168 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1169 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1170 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1171 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1172 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1175 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1178 @cindex Outline mode
1180 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1181 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1182 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1183 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1184 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1185 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1186 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1187 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1189 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1192 @cindex outline tree
1193 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1194 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1195 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1197 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1198 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1199 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1200 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1201 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1202 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1205 * Top level headline
1212 * Another top level headline
1215 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1216 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1217 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1219 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1220 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1221 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1222 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1223 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1224 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1226 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1227 @section Visibility cycling
1228 @cindex cycling, visibility
1229 @cindex visibility cycling
1230 @cindex trees, visibility
1231 @cindex show hidden text
1234 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1235 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1236 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1238 @cindex subtree visibility states
1239 @cindex subtree cycling
1240 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1241 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1242 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1244 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1245 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1248 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1249 '-----------------------------------'
1252 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1253 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1254 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1255 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1256 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1257 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1258 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1259 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1261 @cindex global visibility states
1262 @cindex global cycling
1263 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1264 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1265 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1266 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1267 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1268 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1271 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1272 '--------------------------------------'
1275 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1276 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1277 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1279 @cindex show all, command
1280 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1281 Show all, including drawers.
1282 @cindex revealing context
1283 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1284 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1285 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1286 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1287 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1288 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1289 entire subtree of the parent.
1290 @cindex show branches, command
1291 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1292 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1293 @cindex show children, command
1294 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1295 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1296 expose all children down to level N.
1297 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1298 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1301 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1304 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1306 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1307 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1308 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1309 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1310 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1311 the previously used indirect buffer.
1312 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1313 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1316 @vindex org-startup-folded
1317 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1318 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1319 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1320 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1322 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1323 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1324 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1325 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1332 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1335 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1337 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1338 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1339 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1342 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1343 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1344 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1348 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1350 @cindex motion, between headlines
1351 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1352 @cindex headline navigation
1353 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1356 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1358 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1360 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1361 Next heading same level.
1362 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1363 Previous heading same level.
1364 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1365 Backward to higher level heading.
1366 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1367 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1368 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1369 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1370 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1372 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1373 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1374 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1375 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1376 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1377 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1378 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1380 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1383 @vindex org-goto-interface
1385 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1388 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1389 @section Structure editing
1390 @cindex structure editing
1391 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1392 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1393 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1394 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1395 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1396 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1397 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1398 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1399 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1402 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1403 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1404 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1405 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1406 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1407 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1408 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1409 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1410 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1411 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1412 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@:
1413 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1414 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1415 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1416 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1417 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1418 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1419 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1420 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1421 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1422 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1423 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1424 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1425 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1427 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1428 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1429 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1430 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1431 to the initial level.
1432 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1433 Promote current heading by one level.
1434 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1435 Demote current heading by one level.
1436 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1437 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1438 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1439 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1440 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1441 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1443 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1444 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1445 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1446 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1447 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1448 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1449 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1450 sequential subtrees.
1451 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1452 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1453 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1454 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1455 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1456 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1457 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1458 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1459 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1460 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1461 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1462 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1463 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1464 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1465 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1466 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1467 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1469 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1470 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1471 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1472 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1473 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1474 more details, see the docstring of the command
1475 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1476 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1477 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1478 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1479 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1480 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1481 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1482 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1483 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1484 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1485 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1486 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1487 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1488 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1489 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1490 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1491 Narrow buffer to current block.
1492 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1493 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1494 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1495 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1496 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1497 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1498 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1499 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1500 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1503 @cindex region, active
1504 @cindex active region
1505 @cindex transient mark mode
1506 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1507 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1508 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1509 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1510 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1511 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1515 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1516 @section Sparse trees
1517 @cindex sparse trees
1518 @cindex trees, sparse
1519 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1520 @cindex occur, command
1522 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1523 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1524 @vindex org-show-siblings
1525 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1526 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1527 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1528 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1529 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1530 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1531 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1532 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1533 and you will see immediately how it works.
1535 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1536 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1539 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1540 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1541 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1542 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1543 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1544 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1545 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1546 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1547 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1548 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1549 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1550 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1551 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1552 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1553 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1554 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1555 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1556 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1561 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1562 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1563 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1564 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1565 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1569 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1570 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1573 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1574 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1576 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1577 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1580 @cindex printing sparse trees
1581 @cindex visible text, printing
1582 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1583 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1584 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1585 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1586 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1587 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1589 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1590 @section Plain lists
1592 @cindex lists, plain
1593 @cindex lists, ordered
1594 @cindex ordered lists
1596 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1597 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1598 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1599 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1601 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1604 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1605 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1606 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1607 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1608 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1609 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1612 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1613 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1614 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1615 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1616 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1617 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1618 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1619 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1620 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1621 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1622 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1623 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1624 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1625 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1627 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1628 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1632 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1633 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1634 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1635 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1636 than its bullet/number.
1638 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1639 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1640 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1641 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1642 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1646 ** Lord of the Rings
1647 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1648 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1649 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1650 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1651 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1652 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1654 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1655 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1656 Important actors in this film are:
1657 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1658 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1659 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1663 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1664 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1665 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1666 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1667 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1668 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1669 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1671 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1672 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1673 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1674 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1675 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1676 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1677 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1679 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1680 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1681 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1682 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1683 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1684 to disable them individually.
1687 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1688 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1689 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1690 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1691 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1692 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1693 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1694 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1695 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1696 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1697 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1698 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1699 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1700 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1701 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1702 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1703 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1704 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1705 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1706 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1707 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1708 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1713 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1715 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1716 @kindex S-@key{down}
1719 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1720 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1721 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1722 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1723 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1724 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1725 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1726 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1729 @kindex M-@key{down}
1732 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1733 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1734 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1736 @kindex M-@key{left}
1737 @kindex M-@key{right}
1740 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1741 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1742 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1745 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1746 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1747 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1748 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1749 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1752 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1753 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1754 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1755 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1758 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1759 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1760 consistency in the whole list.
1762 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1763 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1765 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1766 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1767 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1768 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1769 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1770 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1771 active region when calling this, selected text will be changed into an item.
1772 With a prefix argument, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1773 first line already was a list item, any item marker will be removed from the
1774 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1775 converted into a list item.
1778 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1779 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1782 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1783 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1785 @kindex S-@key{left}
1786 @kindex S-@key{right}
1788 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1789 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1790 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1791 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1794 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1795 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1798 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1802 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1805 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1807 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1808 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1809 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1810 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1811 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1815 ** This is a headline
1816 Still outside the drawer
1818 This is inside the drawer.
1823 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1824 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1825 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1826 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1827 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1828 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1830 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1831 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1832 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1833 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1834 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1835 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1836 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1837 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1842 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1845 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1848 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1849 @cindex blocks, folding
1850 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1851 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1852 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1853 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1854 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1855 or on a per-file basis by using
1857 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1858 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1860 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1861 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1864 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1868 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1869 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1870 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1871 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1872 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1873 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1874 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1875 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1878 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1880 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1883 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1884 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1885 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1886 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1887 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1891 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1892 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1895 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1896 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1897 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1898 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1900 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1901 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1902 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1903 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1906 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1907 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1908 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1909 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1912 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1917 The footnote action command.
1919 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1920 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1922 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1923 @vindex org-footnote-section
1924 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1925 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1926 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1927 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1928 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1929 separately into the location determined by the variable
1930 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1932 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1935 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1936 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1937 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1938 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1939 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1940 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1941 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1942 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1943 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1944 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1945 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1946 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1947 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1948 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1949 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1950 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1951 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1954 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1955 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1956 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1961 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1962 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1963 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1967 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1968 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1969 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1972 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1973 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1974 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1975 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1977 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1978 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1979 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1980 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1981 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1984 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1985 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1988 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1989 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1990 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1991 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1992 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1993 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1994 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1997 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2000 @cindex editing tables
2002 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2003 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2004 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2007 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2008 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2009 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2010 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2011 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2012 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2015 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2016 @section The built-in table editor
2017 @cindex table editor, built-in
2019 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with @samp{|} as
2020 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2021 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2022 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2023 might look like this:
2026 | Name | Phone | Age |
2027 |-------+-------+-----|
2028 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2029 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2032 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2033 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2034 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2035 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2036 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2037 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2038 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2039 create the above table, you would only type
2046 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2047 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2048 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2050 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2051 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2052 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2053 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2054 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2055 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2056 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2057 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2058 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2059 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2062 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2063 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2064 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2065 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2066 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2067 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2068 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2069 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2070 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2072 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2073 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2074 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2076 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2077 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2078 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2080 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2081 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2084 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2085 Re-align, move to previous field.
2087 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2088 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2089 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2090 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2092 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2093 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2094 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2095 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2097 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2098 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2099 Move the current column left/right.
2101 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2102 Kill the current column.
2104 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2105 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2107 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2108 Move the current row up/down.
2110 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2111 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2113 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2114 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2115 created below the current one.
2117 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2118 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2119 is created above the current line.
2121 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2122 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2125 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2126 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2127 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2128 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2129 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2130 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2131 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2132 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2133 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2134 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2136 @tsubheading{Regions}
2137 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2138 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2139 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2140 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2142 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2143 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2144 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2146 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2147 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2148 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2149 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2150 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2153 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2154 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2155 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2156 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2157 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2158 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2159 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2162 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2163 @cindex formula, in tables
2164 @cindex calculations, in tables
2165 @cindex region, active
2166 @cindex active region
2167 @cindex transient mark mode
2168 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2169 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2170 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2171 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2173 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2174 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2175 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2176 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2177 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2178 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2179 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2180 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2181 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2183 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2184 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2185 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2186 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2187 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2188 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2189 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2190 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2191 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2193 @item M-x org-table-import
2194 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2195 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2196 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2197 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2198 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2199 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2201 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2202 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2203 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2204 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2206 @item M-x org-table-export
2207 @findex org-table-export
2208 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2209 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2210 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2211 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2212 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2213 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2214 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2215 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2216 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2217 detailed description.
2220 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2221 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2225 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2228 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2229 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2231 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2232 @section Column width and alignment
2233 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2234 @cindex alignment in tables
2236 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2237 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2238 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2240 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2241 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2242 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2243 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2244 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2245 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2246 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2250 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2252 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2253 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2254 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2255 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2256 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2261 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2262 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2263 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2264 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2265 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2266 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2269 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2270 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2271 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2272 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2273 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2274 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2275 on a per-file basis with:
2282 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2283 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2284 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2285 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2286 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2288 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2289 automatically when exporting the document.
2291 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2292 @section Column groups
2293 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2295 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2296 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2297 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2298 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2299 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2300 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2301 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2302 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2303 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2304 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2305 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2308 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2309 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2310 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2311 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2312 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2313 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2314 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2315 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2318 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2319 every vertical line you would like to have:
2322 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2323 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2327 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2328 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2330 @cindex minor mode for tables
2332 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2333 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2334 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2335 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2336 example in Message mode, use
2339 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2342 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2343 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2344 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2345 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2346 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2348 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2349 @section The spreadsheet
2350 @cindex calculations, in tables
2351 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2352 @cindex @file{calc} package
2354 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2355 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2356 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2357 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2358 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2359 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2360 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2361 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2362 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2365 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2366 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2367 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2368 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2369 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2370 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2371 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2372 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2373 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2376 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2377 @subsection References
2380 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2381 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2382 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2383 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2384 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2386 @subsubheading Field references
2387 @cindex field references
2388 @cindex references, to fields
2390 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2391 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2392 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2393 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2394 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2395 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2396 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2397 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2398 representation that looks like this:
2400 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2403 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2404 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e.@: the
2405 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2406 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2407 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2408 column from the right.
2410 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2411 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2412 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2413 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2414 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2415 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2416 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2417 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2418 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2419 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2420 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc@. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2421 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2422 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2423 after the third hline in the table.
2425 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2426 i.e. to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2427 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2430 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2431 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2432 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2433 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2434 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2435 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2437 Here are a few examples:
2440 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2441 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2442 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2443 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2444 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2445 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2448 @subsubheading Range references
2449 @cindex range references
2450 @cindex references, to ranges
2452 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2453 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2454 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2455 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2456 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2457 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2460 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2461 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2462 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2463 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2464 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2465 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2468 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2469 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2470 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2471 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2472 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2474 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2475 @cindex field coordinates
2476 @cindex coordinates, of field
2477 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2478 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2480 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2481 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2482 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2483 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2486 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2487 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2488 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2491 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2492 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2493 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2496 @subsubheading Named references
2497 @cindex named references
2498 @cindex references, named
2499 @cindex name, of column or field
2500 @cindex constants, in calculations
2503 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2504 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2505 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2506 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2510 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2514 @vindex constants-unit-system
2515 @pindex constants.el
2516 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2517 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2518 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2519 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2520 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2521 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2522 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2523 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2524 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2525 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2526 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2527 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2528 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2529 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2532 @subsubheading Remote references
2533 @cindex remote references
2534 @cindex references, remote
2535 @cindex references, to a different table
2536 @cindex name, of column or field
2537 @cindex constants, in calculations
2540 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2541 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2544 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2548 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2549 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2550 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2551 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2552 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2555 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2556 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2557 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2558 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2560 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2561 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2562 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2563 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2564 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2565 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2566 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2567 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2568 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2569 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2570 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2572 @cindex format specifier
2573 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2574 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2575 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2576 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2577 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2578 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2579 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2580 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2581 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2584 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2585 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2586 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2587 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2588 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2589 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2590 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2591 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2592 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2597 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2598 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2599 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2600 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2601 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2602 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2603 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2604 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2605 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2609 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2610 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2611 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2612 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2613 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2614 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2615 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2616 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2617 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2618 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2619 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2622 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2625 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2628 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2629 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2631 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2632 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2633 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2635 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2636 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2637 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2638 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2639 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2640 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2641 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2642 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2643 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2644 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2645 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2646 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2647 without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2648 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2649 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2650 embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2651 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2654 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2655 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2656 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2658 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2659 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2662 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2663 @subsection Durations and time values
2664 @cindex Duration, computing
2665 @cindex Time, computing
2666 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2668 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2669 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2673 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2674 |---------+----------+----------|
2675 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2676 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2677 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2681 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2682 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2683 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2684 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2685 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2686 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2689 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2690 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2692 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2693 @subsection Field and range formulas
2694 @cindex field formula
2695 @cindex range formula
2696 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2697 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2699 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2700 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2701 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2702 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2703 current field will be replaced with the result.
2706 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2707 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2708 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2709 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2710 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2711 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2712 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2713 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2714 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2715 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2716 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2718 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2722 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2723 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2724 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2725 it to the current field, and stores it.
2728 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2729 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2730 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2731 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2736 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2737 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2739 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2742 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2743 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2745 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2748 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2749 @subsection Column formulas
2750 @cindex column formula
2751 @cindex formula, for table column
2753 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2754 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2755 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2756 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2757 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2758 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2759 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2761 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2762 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2763 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2764 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2765 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2766 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2767 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2768 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2769 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2770 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2772 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2776 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2777 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2778 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2779 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2780 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2781 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2784 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2785 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2786 @cindex formula editing
2787 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2789 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2790 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2791 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2792 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2793 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2794 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2795 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2796 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2799 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2800 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2801 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2802 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2803 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2804 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2805 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2806 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2807 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2808 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2809 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2811 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2813 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2814 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2815 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2817 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2819 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2820 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2821 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2822 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2823 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2824 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2825 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2826 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2827 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2829 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2830 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2831 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2832 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2833 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2834 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2835 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2836 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2837 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2838 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2839 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2840 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2841 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2842 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2843 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2845 @kindex S-@key{down}
2846 @kindex S-@key{left}
2847 @kindex S-@key{right}
2848 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2849 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2850 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2851 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2852 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2853 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2854 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2855 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2856 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2857 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2859 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2860 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2862 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2864 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2868 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2869 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2870 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2871 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2872 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2875 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2876 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2877 recalculation commands in the table.
2879 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2880 @cindex formula debugging
2881 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2882 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2883 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2884 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2885 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2886 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2887 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2889 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2890 @subsection Updating the table
2891 @cindex recomputing table fields
2892 @cindex updating, table
2894 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2895 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2896 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2898 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2902 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2903 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2904 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2910 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2911 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2913 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2914 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2915 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2916 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2917 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2918 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2919 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2920 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2921 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2922 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2926 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2927 @subsection Advanced features
2929 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2930 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2931 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2932 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2933 special marking characters.
2936 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2937 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2938 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2939 change all marks in the region.
2942 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2943 makes use of these features:
2947 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2948 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2949 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2950 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2951 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2952 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2953 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2954 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2955 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2956 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2957 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2958 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2959 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2960 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2961 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2965 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2966 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2967 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2968 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2971 @cindex marking characters, tables
2972 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2975 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2976 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2978 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2979 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2980 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2981 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2983 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2986 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2987 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2988 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2989 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2992 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2993 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2994 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2995 lines will be left alone by this command.
2997 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2998 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2999 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3001 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3002 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3005 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3006 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3009 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3010 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3011 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3016 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3017 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3018 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3019 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3020 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3021 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3022 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3023 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3024 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3025 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3026 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3030 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3032 @cindex graph, in tables
3033 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3036 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3037 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3038 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3039 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3040 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3044 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3045 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3046 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3047 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3048 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3049 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3050 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3051 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3055 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3056 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3057 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3058 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3059 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3060 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3062 @subsubheading Plot Options
3066 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3069 Specify the title of the plot.
3072 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3075 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3076 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3077 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3081 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3084 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3085 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3086 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3089 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3092 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3096 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3099 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3100 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3103 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3104 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3107 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3108 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3109 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3110 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3111 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3115 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3119 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3120 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3123 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3124 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3125 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3126 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3127 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3128 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3129 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3130 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3133 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3134 @section Link format
3136 @cindex format, of links
3138 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3139 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3142 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3146 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3147 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3148 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3149 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3150 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3151 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3152 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3153 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3156 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3157 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3158 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3159 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3160 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3161 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3162 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3164 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3165 @section Internal links
3166 @cindex internal links
3167 @cindex links, internal
3168 @cindex targets, for links
3170 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3171 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3172 current file. The most important case is a link like
3173 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3174 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3175 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3176 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3179 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3180 lead to a text search in the current file.
3182 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3183 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3184 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3185 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3186 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3187 comment line. For example
3193 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3194 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3195 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3196 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3199 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3200 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3201 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3202 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3203 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3204 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3205 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3207 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3208 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3209 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3213 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3216 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3217 @subsection Radio targets
3218 @cindex radio targets
3219 @cindex targets, radio
3220 @cindex links, radio targets
3222 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3223 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3224 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3225 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3226 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3227 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3228 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3229 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3230 cursor on or at a target.
3232 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3233 @section External links
3234 @cindex links, external
3235 @cindex external links
3236 @cindex links, external
3244 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3246 @cindex USENET links
3251 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3252 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3253 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3254 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3255 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3258 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3259 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3260 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3261 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3262 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3263 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3264 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3265 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3266 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3267 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3268 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3269 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3270 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3271 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3272 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3273 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3274 will be queried to create it.}
3275 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3276 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3277 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3278 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3279 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3280 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3281 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3282 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3283 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3284 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3285 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3286 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3287 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3288 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3289 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3290 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3291 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3292 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3293 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3294 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3295 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3296 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3297 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3298 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3299 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3300 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3303 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3305 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3306 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3307 format}), for example:
3310 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3314 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3315 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3316 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3318 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3320 @cindex square brackets, around links
3321 @cindex plain text external links
3322 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3323 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3324 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3325 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3327 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3328 @section Handling links
3329 @cindex links, handling
3331 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3332 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3335 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3336 @cindex storing links
3337 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3338 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3339 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3340 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3343 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3344 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3345 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3346 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3347 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3348 timestamp in the headline.}.
3350 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3351 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3352 @cindex property, ID
3353 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3354 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3355 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3356 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3357 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3358 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3359 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3362 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3363 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3364 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3365 constructed from the author and the subject.
3367 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3368 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3370 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3371 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3374 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3375 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3376 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3377 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3378 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3381 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3382 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3383 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3384 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3385 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3386 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3387 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3390 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3391 entry referenced by the current line.
3394 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3395 @cindex link completion
3396 @cindex completion, of links
3397 @cindex inserting links
3398 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3399 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3400 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3401 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3402 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3403 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3404 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3405 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3406 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3407 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3408 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3409 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3410 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3411 becomes the default description.
3413 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3414 All links stored during the
3415 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3416 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3418 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3419 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3420 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3421 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3422 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3423 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3424 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3425 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3426 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3428 @cindex file name completion
3429 @cindex completion, of file names
3430 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3431 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3432 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3433 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3434 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3435 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3436 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3437 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3439 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3440 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3441 link and description parts of the link.
3443 @cindex following links
3444 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3445 @vindex org-file-apps
3446 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3447 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3448 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3449 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3450 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3451 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3452 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3453 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3454 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3455 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3456 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3457 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3458 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3459 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3460 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3461 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3464 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3465 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3472 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3473 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3477 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3478 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3479 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3480 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3482 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3483 @cindex inlining images
3484 @cindex images, inlining
3485 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3486 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3487 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3488 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3489 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3490 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3491 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3492 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3493 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3494 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3495 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3497 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3498 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3500 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3501 @cindex links, returning to
3502 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3503 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3504 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3505 previously recorded positions.
3507 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3508 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3509 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3510 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3511 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3512 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3514 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3516 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3517 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3521 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3522 @section Using links outside Org
3524 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3525 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3526 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3530 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3531 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3534 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3535 @section Link abbreviations
3536 @cindex link abbreviations
3537 @cindex abbreviation, links
3539 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3540 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3541 abbreviated link looks like this
3544 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3548 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3549 where the tag is optional.
3550 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3551 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3552 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3553 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3557 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3558 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3559 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3560 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3561 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3562 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3566 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3567 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3568 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3569 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3571 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3572 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3573 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3574 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3575 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3576 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3577 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3579 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3580 can define them in the file with
3584 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3585 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3589 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3590 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3591 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3592 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3593 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3595 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3596 @section Search options in file links
3597 @cindex search option in file links
3598 @cindex file links, searching
3600 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3601 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3602 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3603 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3604 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3605 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3606 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3607 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3609 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3610 link, together with an explanation:
3613 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3614 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3615 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3616 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3617 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3624 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3625 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3626 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3627 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3630 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3632 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3634 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3635 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3636 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3637 sparse tree with the matches.
3638 @c If the target file is a directory,
3639 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3642 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3643 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3644 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3645 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3647 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3648 @section Custom Searches
3649 @cindex custom search strings
3650 @cindex search strings, custom
3652 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3653 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3654 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3655 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3656 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3659 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3660 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3661 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3662 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3663 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3664 to be added to the hook variables
3665 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3666 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3667 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3668 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3669 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3671 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3675 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3676 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3677 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3678 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3679 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3680 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3681 item emerged is always present.
3683 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3684 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3685 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3688 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3689 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3690 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3691 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3692 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3693 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3696 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3697 @section Basic TODO functionality
3699 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3700 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3703 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3707 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3710 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3711 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3712 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3715 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3716 '--------------------------------'
3719 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3720 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3722 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3723 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3724 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3725 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3728 @kindex S-@key{right}
3729 @kindex S-@key{left}
3730 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3731 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3732 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3733 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3734 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3735 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3736 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3737 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3738 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3739 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3740 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3741 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3742 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3743 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3744 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3745 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3746 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3747 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3748 both un-done and done.
3749 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3750 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3751 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3752 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3753 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3754 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3755 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3756 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3760 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3761 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3762 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3764 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3765 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3766 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3768 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3769 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3770 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3771 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3772 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3775 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3776 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3779 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3780 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3781 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3782 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3783 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3784 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3785 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3788 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3789 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3790 @cindex TODO workflow
3791 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3793 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3794 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3795 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3799 (setq org-todo-keywords
3800 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3803 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3804 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3805 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3807 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3808 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3809 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3810 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3811 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3812 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3813 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3814 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3815 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3816 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3817 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3819 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3820 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3822 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3823 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3825 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3826 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3827 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3828 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3829 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3830 be set up like this:
3833 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3836 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3837 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3838 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3839 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3840 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3841 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3842 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3843 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3844 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3845 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3846 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3847 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3848 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3849 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3851 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3852 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3853 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3855 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3856 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3857 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3858 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3859 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3863 (setq org-todo-keywords
3864 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3865 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3866 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3869 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3870 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3871 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3872 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3873 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3874 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3875 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3878 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3879 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3880 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3881 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3882 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3883 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3884 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3885 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3886 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3887 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3888 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3889 @kindex S-@key{right}
3890 @kindex S-@key{left}
3893 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3894 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3895 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3896 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3897 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3900 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3901 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3903 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3904 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3905 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3906 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3909 (setq org-todo-keywords
3910 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3911 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3912 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3915 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3916 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3917 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3918 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3919 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3920 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3921 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3922 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3924 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3925 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3926 @cindex keyword options
3927 @cindex per-file keywords
3932 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3933 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3934 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3935 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3936 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3940 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3942 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3943 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3945 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3948 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3952 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3956 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3958 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3959 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3961 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3962 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3963 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3964 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3965 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3966 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3967 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3968 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3969 for the current buffer.}.
3971 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3972 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3973 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3975 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3976 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3977 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3978 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3979 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3980 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3981 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3982 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3983 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3987 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3988 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3989 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3993 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3994 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3995 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3996 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3997 foreground or a background color.
3999 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4000 @subsection TODO dependencies
4001 @cindex TODO dependencies
4002 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4004 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4005 @cindex property, ORDERED
4006 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4007 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4008 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
4009 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4010 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4011 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4012 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
4013 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4014 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
4018 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4027 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4028 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4032 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4033 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4034 @cindex property, ORDERED
4035 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4036 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4037 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4038 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4039 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4040 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4041 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4044 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4045 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4046 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4047 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4049 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4050 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4051 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4052 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4053 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4054 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4056 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4057 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4058 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4061 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4062 @section Progress logging
4063 @cindex progress logging
4064 @cindex logging, of progress
4066 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4067 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4068 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4069 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4070 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4074 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4075 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4076 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4079 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4080 @subsection Closing items
4082 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4083 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4084 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4087 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4091 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4092 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4093 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4094 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4095 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4096 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4099 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4103 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4104 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4106 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4107 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4108 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4109 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4111 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4112 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4113 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4115 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4116 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4117 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4118 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4119 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4120 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4121 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4122 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4123 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4124 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4125 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4126 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4127 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4128 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4129 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4130 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4132 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4133 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4134 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4135 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4139 (setq org-todo-keywords
4140 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4143 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4144 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4147 @vindex org-log-done
4148 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4149 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4150 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4151 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4152 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4153 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4154 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4155 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4156 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4157 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4158 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4159 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4160 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4161 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4162 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4165 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4168 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4171 @cindex property, LOGGING
4172 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4173 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4174 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4175 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4176 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4177 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4180 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4182 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4184 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4186 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4188 * TODO No logging at all
4194 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4195 @subsection Tracking your habits
4198 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4199 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4203 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4206 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4208 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4210 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4211 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4212 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4213 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4215 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4216 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4217 three days, but at most every two days.
4219 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
4220 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not
4221 enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4225 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4226 actual habit with some history:
4230 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4231 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4232 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4233 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4234 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4235 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4236 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4237 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4238 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4239 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4240 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4243 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4247 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4248 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4249 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4250 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4251 after four days have elapsed.
4253 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4254 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4255 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4256 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4260 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4262 If the task could have been done on that day.
4264 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4266 If the task was overdue on that day.
4269 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4270 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4271 the current day falls in the graph.
4273 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4274 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4277 @item org-habit-graph-column
4278 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4279 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4280 titles brief and to the point.
4281 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4282 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4283 @item org-habit-following-days
4284 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4285 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4286 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4290 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4291 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4292 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4293 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4295 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4299 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4300 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4301 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4304 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4308 @vindex org-priority-faces
4309 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4310 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4311 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4312 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4313 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4314 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4316 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4322 @findex org-priority
4323 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4324 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4325 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4326 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4327 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4329 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4330 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4331 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4332 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4333 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4334 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4335 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4338 @vindex org-highest-priority
4339 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4340 @vindex org-default-priority
4341 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4342 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4343 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4344 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4345 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4348 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4353 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4354 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4355 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4356 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4358 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4359 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4360 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4361 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4362 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4363 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4364 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4365 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4366 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4369 * Organize Party [33%]
4370 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4374 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4377 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4378 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4379 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4380 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4383 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4384 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4385 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4386 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4387 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4391 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4393 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4397 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4398 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4401 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4402 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4403 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4404 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4406 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4410 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4411 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4414 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4418 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4419 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4420 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4421 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4422 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4423 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4424 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4425 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4426 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4427 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4429 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4432 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4433 - [-] call people [1/3]
4438 - [ ] think about what music to play
4439 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4442 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4443 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4444 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4447 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4448 @cindex checkbox statistics
4449 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4450 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4451 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4452 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4453 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4454 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4455 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4456 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4457 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4458 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4459 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4460 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4461 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4462 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4463 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4464 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4465 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4466 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4467 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4469 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4470 @cindex checkbox blocking
4471 @cindex property, ORDERED
4472 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4473 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4474 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4476 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4479 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4480 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4481 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4482 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4483 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4484 considered to be an intermediate state.
4485 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4486 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4487 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4491 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4492 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4493 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4495 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4496 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4498 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4500 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4501 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4502 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4503 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4504 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4505 @cindex property, ORDERED
4506 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4507 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4508 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4509 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4510 for better visibility, customize the variable
4511 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4512 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4513 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4514 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4515 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4516 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4517 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4518 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4521 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4524 @cindex headline tagging
4525 @cindex matching, tags
4526 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4528 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4529 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4532 @vindex org-tag-faces
4533 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4534 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4535 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4536 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4537 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4538 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4539 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4540 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4543 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4544 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4545 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4548 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4549 @section Tag inheritance
4550 @cindex tag inheritance
4551 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4552 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4554 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4555 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4556 well. For example, in the list
4559 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4560 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4561 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4565 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4566 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4567 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4568 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4569 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4570 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4571 changes in the line.}:
4575 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4579 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4580 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4581 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4582 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4583 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4585 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4586 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4587 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4588 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4589 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4590 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4591 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4592 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4594 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4595 @section Setting tags
4596 @cindex setting tags
4597 @cindex tags, setting
4600 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4601 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4602 also a special command for inserting tags:
4605 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4606 @cindex completion, of tags
4607 @vindex org-tags-column
4608 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4609 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4610 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4611 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4612 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4613 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4614 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4615 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4616 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4619 @vindex org-tag-alist
4620 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4621 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4622 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4623 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4624 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4628 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4629 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4632 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4633 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4634 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4640 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4641 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4642 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4643 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4644 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4645 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4651 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4652 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4653 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4654 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4655 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4656 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4657 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4658 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4662 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4665 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4666 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4669 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4672 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4673 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4674 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4677 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4680 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4683 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4684 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4688 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4692 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4695 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4696 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4698 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4699 these lines to activate any changes.
4702 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4703 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4704 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4705 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4709 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4710 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4711 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4713 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4716 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4717 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4718 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4719 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4720 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4725 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4726 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4727 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4730 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4731 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4732 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4736 Clear all tags for this line.
4739 Accept the modified set.
4741 Abort without installing changes.
4743 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4745 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4746 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4748 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4749 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4754 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4755 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4756 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4757 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4758 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4759 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4760 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4761 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4763 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4764 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4765 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4766 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4767 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4768 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4769 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4770 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4771 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4772 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4773 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4775 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4776 @section Tag searches
4777 @cindex tag searches
4778 @cindex searching for tags
4780 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4781 information into special lists.
4784 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4785 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4786 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4787 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4788 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4789 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4790 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4791 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4792 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4793 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4794 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4797 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4798 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4799 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4800 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4801 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4802 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4803 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4806 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4807 @chapter Properties and columns
4810 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4811 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4812 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4814 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4815 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4816 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4817 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4818 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4819 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4820 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4821 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4822 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4824 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4825 (@pxref{Column view}).
4828 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4829 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4830 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4831 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4832 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4833 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4836 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4837 @section Property syntax
4838 @cindex property syntax
4839 @cindex drawer, for properties
4841 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4842 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4843 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4844 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4845 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4850 *** Goldberg Variations
4852 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4853 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4855 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4860 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4861 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4862 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4864 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4865 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4866 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4867 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4868 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4869 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4870 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4875 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4876 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4880 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4881 file, use a line like
4882 @cindex property, _ALL
4885 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4888 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4889 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4890 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4893 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4894 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4897 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4898 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4899 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4907 *** Goldberg Variations
4909 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4910 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4912 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4917 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4919 @vindex org-global-properties
4920 Property values set with the global variable
4921 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4925 The following commands help to work with properties:
4928 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4929 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4930 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4931 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4932 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4933 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4934 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4935 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4936 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4937 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4938 information like deadlines.
4939 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4940 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4941 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4942 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4943 can be inserted using completion.
4944 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4945 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4946 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4947 Remove a property from the current entry.
4948 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4949 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4950 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4951 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4952 nearest column format definition.
4955 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4956 @section Special properties
4957 @cindex properties, special
4959 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4960 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4961 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4962 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4963 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4964 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4966 @cindex property, special, ID
4967 @cindex property, special, TODO
4968 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4969 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4970 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4971 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4972 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4973 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4974 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4975 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4976 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4977 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4978 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4979 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4980 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4981 @cindex property, special, FILE
4983 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
4984 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
4985 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4986 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4987 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4988 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4989 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4990 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4991 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4992 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4993 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4994 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4995 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4996 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
4997 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4998 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
4999 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5002 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5003 @section Property searches
5004 @cindex properties, searching
5005 @cindex searching, of properties
5007 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5008 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5010 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
5011 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5012 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5013 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5014 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5015 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5016 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5017 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5018 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5019 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5020 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5023 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5026 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5031 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5032 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5033 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5034 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5035 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5038 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5039 @section Property Inheritance
5040 @cindex properties, inheritance
5041 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5043 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5044 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5045 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5046 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5047 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5048 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5049 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5050 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5051 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5052 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5053 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5054 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5055 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5057 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5058 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5060 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5063 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5064 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5065 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5066 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5067 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5069 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5070 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5071 applies to the entire subtree.
5073 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5074 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5075 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5077 @cindex property, LOGGING
5078 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5079 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5082 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5083 @section Column view
5085 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5086 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5087 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5088 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5089 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5090 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5091 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5092 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5093 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5094 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5095 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5096 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5097 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5100 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5101 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5102 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5105 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5106 @subsection Defining columns
5107 @cindex column view, for properties
5108 @cindex properties, column view
5110 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5111 done by defining a column format line.
5114 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5115 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5118 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5119 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5121 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5125 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5128 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5129 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5132 ** Top node for columns view
5134 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5138 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5139 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5140 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5141 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5142 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5143 deeper part of the tree.
5145 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5146 @subsubsection Column attributes
5147 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5148 definition looks like this:
5151 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5155 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5156 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5159 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5160 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5161 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5162 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5163 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5164 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5166 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5167 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5168 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5169 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5170 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5171 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5172 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5173 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5174 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5175 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5176 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5177 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5178 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5179 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5180 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5181 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5182 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5183 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5184 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5185 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5189 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5190 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5191 same summary information.
5193 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5194 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5195 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5196 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5197 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5198 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5200 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5201 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5202 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5203 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5204 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5205 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5206 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5207 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5209 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5213 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5214 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5215 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5216 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5217 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5221 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5222 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
5223 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5224 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5225 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5226 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5227 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5228 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5229 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5230 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5231 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5232 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5233 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
5236 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5237 @subsection Using column view
5240 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5241 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5242 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5243 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5244 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5245 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5246 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5247 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5248 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5249 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5250 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5251 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5252 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5253 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5254 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5256 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5258 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5259 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5260 Move through the column view from field to field.
5261 @kindex S-@key{left}
5262 @kindex S-@key{right}
5263 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5264 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5265 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5267 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5268 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5269 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5270 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5271 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5272 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5273 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5274 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5275 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5276 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5277 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5278 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5279 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5280 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5281 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5282 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5283 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5284 current column view.
5285 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5286 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5287 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5288 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5289 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5290 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5291 Delete the current column.
5294 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5295 @subsection Capturing column view
5297 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5298 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5299 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5300 of this block looks like this:
5302 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5305 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5310 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5314 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5315 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5316 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5317 capture, you can use 4 values:
5318 @cindex property, ID
5320 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5321 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5322 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5323 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5324 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5325 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5326 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5327 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5330 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5331 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5333 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5335 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5336 @item :skip-empty-rows
5337 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5338 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5343 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5346 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5347 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5348 for the scope or ID of the view.
5349 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5350 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5351 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5352 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5353 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5354 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5358 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5359 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5360 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5361 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5363 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5364 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5365 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5366 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5367 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5368 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5369 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5371 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5372 @section The Property API
5373 @cindex properties, API
5374 @cindex API, for properties
5376 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5377 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5378 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5381 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5382 @chapter Dates and times
5388 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5389 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5390 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5391 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5392 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5393 is used in a much wider sense.
5396 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5397 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5398 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5399 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5400 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5401 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5402 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5406 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5407 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5409 @cindex ranges, time
5414 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5415 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5416 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5417 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5418 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5419 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5420 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5421 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5422 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5423 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5426 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5429 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5430 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5431 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5432 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5435 * Meet Peter at the movies
5436 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5437 * Discussion on climate change
5438 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5441 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5442 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5443 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5444 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5445 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5446 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5449 * Pick up Sam at school
5450 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5453 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5454 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5455 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5456 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5457 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5458 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5459 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5460 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5461 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5462 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5463 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5464 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5465 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5466 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5467 example with optional time
5470 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5471 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5474 @item Time/Date range
5477 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5478 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5479 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5482 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5483 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5486 @item Inactive timestamp
5487 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5488 @cindex inactive timestamp
5489 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5490 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5491 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5494 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5500 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5501 @section Creating timestamps
5502 @cindex creating timestamps
5503 @cindex timestamps, creating
5505 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5506 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5510 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5511 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5512 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5513 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5514 succession, a time range is inserted.
5516 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5517 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5524 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5525 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5526 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5527 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5530 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5532 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5533 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5535 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5536 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5537 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5540 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5541 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5542 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5544 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5545 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5546 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5548 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5549 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5550 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5551 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5552 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5553 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5554 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5555 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5556 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5558 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5559 @cindex evaluate time range
5560 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5561 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5562 the following column).
5567 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5568 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5571 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5572 @subsection The date/time prompt
5573 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5574 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5576 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5577 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5578 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5579 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5580 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5581 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5582 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5583 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5584 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5585 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5586 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5587 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5588 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5589 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5590 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5591 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5592 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5593 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5595 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5596 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5600 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5601 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5602 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5603 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5604 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5605 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5606 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5607 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5608 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5609 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5610 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5611 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5612 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5613 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5616 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5617 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5618 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5619 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5620 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5621 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5622 the Nth such day, e.g.@:
5627 +4d @result{} four days from today
5628 +4 @result{} same as above
5629 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5630 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5631 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5634 @vindex parse-time-months
5635 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5636 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5637 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5638 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5640 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5641 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5642 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5643 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5644 read the docstring of the variable
5645 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5647 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5648 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5649 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5653 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5654 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5655 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5658 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5659 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5660 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5661 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5662 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5663 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5664 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5665 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5666 from the minibuffer:
5673 @kindex S-@key{right}
5674 @kindex S-@key{left}
5675 @kindex S-@key{down}
5677 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5678 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5681 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5682 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5683 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5684 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5685 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5686 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5687 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5690 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5691 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5692 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5693 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5694 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5695 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5696 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5698 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5699 @subsection Custom time format
5700 @cindex custom date/time format
5701 @cindex time format, custom
5702 @cindex date format, custom
5704 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5705 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5706 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5707 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5708 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5709 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5710 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5713 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5714 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5718 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5719 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5720 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5721 following consequences:
5724 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5727 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5728 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5729 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5730 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5731 time will be changed by one minute.
5733 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5734 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5736 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5737 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5738 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5740 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5741 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5742 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5746 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5747 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5749 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5753 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5755 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5756 to be finished on that date.
5758 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5759 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5760 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5761 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5762 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5763 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5766 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5767 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5768 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5771 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5772 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5773 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5776 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5778 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5781 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5782 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5783 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5784 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5785 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5786 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5787 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5790 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5791 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5795 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5796 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5797 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5798 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5799 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5800 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5801 want to start working on an action item.
5804 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5805 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5806 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5807 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5809 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5811 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5812 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5813 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5817 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5818 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5821 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5822 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5824 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5825 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5826 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5831 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5832 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5833 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5834 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5835 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5836 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5837 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5840 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5841 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5842 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5843 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5844 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5845 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5846 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5847 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5850 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5853 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5854 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5855 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5856 schedule the marked item.
5858 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5859 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5860 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5861 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5862 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5863 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5864 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5865 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5867 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5868 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5870 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5871 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5874 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5875 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g. +1d will set
5876 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5877 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5879 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5880 @subsection Repeated tasks
5881 @cindex tasks, repeated
5882 @cindex repeated tasks
5884 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5885 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5886 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5888 ** TODO Pay the rent
5889 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5892 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5893 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5894 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5895 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5896 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5897 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5899 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5900 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5901 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5902 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5903 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5904 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5905 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5906 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5907 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5908 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5909 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5910 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5911 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5912 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5913 switch the date like this:
5916 ** TODO Pay the rent
5917 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5920 @vindex org-log-repeat
5921 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5922 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5923 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5924 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5925 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5927 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5928 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5931 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5932 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5933 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5934 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5935 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5936 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5937 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5938 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5939 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5943 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5944 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5945 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5946 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5947 and marked it done on Saturday.
5948 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5949 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5950 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5954 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5955 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5957 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5958 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5959 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5962 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5963 @section Clocking work time
5964 @cindex clocking time
5965 @cindex time clocking
5967 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5968 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
5969 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
5970 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
5971 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
5972 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
5973 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
5974 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
5975 number of tasks absorbing your time.
5977 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5979 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5980 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5982 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5983 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5984 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5985 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5989 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5990 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5991 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5994 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5995 @subsection Clocking commands
5998 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5999 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6000 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6001 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6002 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6003 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6004 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6005 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6006 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6007 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6008 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6009 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6010 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
6011 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
6012 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
6013 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6014 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6015 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6016 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6017 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6018 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6019 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6020 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6021 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6022 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6023 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6024 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6025 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6026 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6027 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6028 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6029 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6030 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6031 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6033 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6034 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6035 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6036 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6037 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6038 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6039 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6040 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6041 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6042 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6043 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6046 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6047 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6048 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6049 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6050 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6051 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps at the same
6052 time so that duration keeps the same.
6053 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6054 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6055 if it is running in this same item.
6056 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
6057 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6058 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6059 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6060 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6061 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6062 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6063 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6064 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6065 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6066 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6067 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6068 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6072 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6073 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6074 worked on or closed during a day.
6076 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6077 @subsection The clock table
6078 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6079 @cindex report, of clocked time
6081 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6082 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6083 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6086 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6087 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6088 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6089 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6090 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6091 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6092 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6093 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6094 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6095 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6096 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6097 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6098 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6099 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6100 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6101 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6102 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6106 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6107 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6109 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6111 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6115 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6116 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6117 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6118 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6120 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6123 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6124 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6125 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6126 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6127 file @r{the full current buffer}
6128 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6129 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6130 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6131 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6132 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6133 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6134 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6135 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6136 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6138 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6139 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6140 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6141 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6142 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6143 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6144 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6145 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6146 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6147 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6148 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6149 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6150 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6151 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6152 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6153 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6154 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6155 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6158 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6159 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6160 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6162 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6163 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6164 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6165 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6166 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6167 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6168 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6169 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6170 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6171 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6172 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6173 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6174 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6175 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6176 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6177 @r{property will get its own column.}
6178 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6179 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6180 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6181 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6182 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6183 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6185 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6186 day, you could write
6188 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6192 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6193 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6194 only to fit it into the manual.}
6196 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6197 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6200 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6202 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6205 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6208 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6212 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6213 @subsection Resolving idle time
6214 @cindex resolve idle time
6216 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6217 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6218 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6219 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6220 applying it to another one.
6222 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6223 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6224 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6225 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6226 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6227 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6228 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
6229 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
6230 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
6231 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
6232 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
6233 choices to correct the discrepancy:
6237 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6238 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6239 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6241 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6242 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6243 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6245 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6246 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6248 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6249 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6250 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6252 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6253 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6254 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6255 log with an empty entry.
6258 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6259 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6260 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6261 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6262 the next task you clock in on.
6264 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6265 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6266 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6267 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6268 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6270 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6271 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6272 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6273 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6274 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6275 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6277 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6278 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
6280 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6281 @section Effort estimates
6282 @cindex effort estimates
6284 @cindex property, Effort
6285 @vindex org-effort-property
6286 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6287 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6288 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6289 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6290 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6291 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6292 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6293 for an entry with the following commands:
6296 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6297 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6298 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6299 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6300 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6301 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6304 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6305 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6306 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6307 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6311 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6312 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6316 @vindex org-global-properties
6317 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6318 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6319 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6320 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6321 setup may be advised.
6323 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6324 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6325 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6326 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6328 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6329 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6330 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6331 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6332 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6333 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6334 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6335 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6336 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6338 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6339 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6340 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6341 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6343 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6344 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6345 @cindex relative timer
6347 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6348 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6349 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6352 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6353 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6354 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6356 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6357 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6358 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6359 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6360 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6362 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6365 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6366 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6367 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6368 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6370 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6371 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6372 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6373 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6374 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6375 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6376 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6377 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6378 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6379 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6380 not started at exactly the right moment.
6383 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6384 @section Countdown timer
6385 @cindex Countdown timer
6389 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6390 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6392 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6393 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6394 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6397 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6398 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6401 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6402 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6403 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6404 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6405 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6406 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6409 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6410 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6411 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6412 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6413 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6414 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6417 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6421 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6422 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6423 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6424 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6425 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6427 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6428 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6430 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6432 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6433 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6434 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6435 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6437 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6438 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6439 does enhance it with templates and more.
6442 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6443 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6444 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6447 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6448 @subsection Setting up capture
6450 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6451 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6452 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6454 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6456 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6457 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6460 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6461 @subsection Using capture
6464 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6465 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6466 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6468 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6469 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6470 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6471 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6473 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6474 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6475 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6476 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6477 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6479 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6480 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6481 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6482 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6483 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6484 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6485 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6487 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6488 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6492 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6493 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6494 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6495 rather than to the current date.
6497 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6502 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6503 template in the usual way.
6504 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6505 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6508 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6509 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6510 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6511 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6514 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6515 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6517 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6518 @subsection Capture templates
6519 @cindex templates, for Capture
6521 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6522 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6523 through the customize interface.
6527 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6530 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6531 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6532 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6533 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6534 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6538 (setq org-capture-templates
6539 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6540 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6541 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6542 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6545 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6549 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6553 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6554 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6555 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6556 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6557 place where you started the capture process.
6559 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6560 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6564 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6565 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6569 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6570 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6573 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6574 @subsubsection Template elements
6576 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6577 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6581 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6582 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6583 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6584 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6585 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6586 prefix key, for example
6588 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6590 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6591 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6594 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6598 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6601 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6602 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6604 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6605 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6607 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6610 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6611 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6612 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6614 Text to be inserted as it is.
6618 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6619 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6620 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6621 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6622 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6623 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6624 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6628 @item (file "path/to/file")
6629 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6631 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6632 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6634 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6635 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6637 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6638 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6640 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6641 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6643 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6644 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6646 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6647 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6649 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6650 A function to find the right location in the file.
6653 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6655 @item (function function-finding-location)
6656 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6661 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6662 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6663 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6664 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6665 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6669 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6670 Recognized properties are:
6673 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6674 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6675 Setting this property will change that.
6677 @item :immediate-finish
6678 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6679 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6680 information that can be added automatically.
6683 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6684 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6687 Start the clock in this item.
6690 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6693 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6694 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6695 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6696 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6699 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6700 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6702 @item :table-line-pos
6703 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6704 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6705 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6709 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6710 buffer again after capture is completed.
6714 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6715 @subsubsection Template expansion
6717 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6718 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6719 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6722 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6723 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6724 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6725 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6726 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6727 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6728 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6729 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6730 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6731 @r{region is active.}
6732 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6733 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6734 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6735 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6736 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6737 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6738 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6739 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6740 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6741 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6742 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6743 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6744 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6745 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6746 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6747 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6748 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6749 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6750 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6751 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6752 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6753 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6754 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6755 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6759 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6760 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6761 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6762 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6765 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6767 Link type | Available keywords
6768 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6769 bbdb | %:name %:company
6770 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6771 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6772 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6773 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6774 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6775 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6776 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6777 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6778 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6780 info | %:file %:node
6785 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6788 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6792 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6793 @section Attachments
6796 @vindex org-attach-directory
6797 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6798 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6799 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6800 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6801 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6802 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6803 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6804 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6805 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6806 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6807 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6808 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6809 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6811 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6812 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6813 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6816 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6820 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6821 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6822 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6823 to select a command:
6826 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6827 @vindex org-attach-method
6828 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6829 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6830 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6836 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6837 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6839 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6840 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6842 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6843 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6844 attachments yourself.
6846 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6847 @vindex org-file-apps
6848 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6849 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6850 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6851 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6853 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6854 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6856 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6857 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6859 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6860 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6862 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6863 Select and delete a single attachment.
6865 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6866 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6867 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6869 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6870 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6871 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6872 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6874 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6875 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6876 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6877 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6881 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6886 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6887 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6888 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6889 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6890 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6891 information. Here is just an example:
6894 (setq org-feed-alist
6896 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6897 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6901 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6902 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6903 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6904 the following command is used:
6907 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6909 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6911 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6912 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6915 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6916 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6917 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6918 list of drawers in that file:
6921 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6924 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6925 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6927 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6928 @section Protocols for external access
6929 @cindex protocols, for external access
6932 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6933 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6934 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6935 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6936 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6937 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6938 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6939 documentation and setup instructions.
6941 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6942 @section Refiling notes
6943 @cindex refiling notes
6945 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6946 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6947 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6948 process, you can use the following special command:
6951 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6952 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6953 @vindex org-refile-targets
6954 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6955 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6956 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6957 @vindex org-log-refile
6958 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6959 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6960 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6961 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6962 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6964 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6965 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6966 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6967 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6968 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6969 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6970 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6971 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6972 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6973 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6974 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
6975 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6976 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6977 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6978 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6979 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6981 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6982 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6983 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6984 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6985 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6988 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6992 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6993 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6994 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6995 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6998 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6999 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7000 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7001 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7005 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7006 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7009 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7010 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7011 @cindex external archiving
7013 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7017 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7018 @vindex org-archive-location
7019 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7020 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7021 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7022 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7023 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7024 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7025 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7026 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7029 @cindex archive locations
7030 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7031 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7032 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7033 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7034 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7035 see the documentation string of the variable
7036 @code{org-archive-location}.
7038 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7039 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7040 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7041 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7042 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7043 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7044 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7045 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7049 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7052 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7054 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7055 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7056 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7058 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7059 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7060 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7061 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7062 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7066 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7067 @subsection Internal archiving
7069 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7070 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7072 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7073 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7076 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7077 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7078 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7079 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7080 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7081 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7083 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7084 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7085 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7086 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7088 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7089 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7090 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7091 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7092 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7093 temporarily included.
7095 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7096 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7097 is. Configure the details using the variable
7098 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7100 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7101 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7102 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7105 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7108 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7109 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7110 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7112 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7113 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7114 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7115 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7116 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7117 level 1 trees will be checked.
7118 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7119 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7120 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7121 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7122 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7123 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7124 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7129 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7130 @chapter Agenda views
7131 @cindex agenda views
7133 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7134 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7135 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7136 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7137 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7139 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7140 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7144 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7147 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7150 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7151 TODO state associated with them,
7153 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7154 in time-sorted view,
7156 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7157 that contain specified keywords,
7159 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7162 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7167 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7168 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7169 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7170 edit these files remotely.
7172 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7173 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7174 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7175 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7176 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7177 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7180 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7181 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7182 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7183 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7184 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7185 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7186 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7187 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7190 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7191 @section Agenda files
7192 @cindex agenda files
7193 @cindex files for agenda
7195 @vindex org-agenda-files
7196 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7197 files}, the files listed in the variable
7198 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7199 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7200 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7201 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7204 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7205 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7206 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7207 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7208 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7209 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7211 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7213 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7214 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7215 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7216 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7217 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7218 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7220 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7221 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7223 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7224 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7225 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7226 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7231 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7232 to visit any of them.
7234 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7235 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7236 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7237 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7238 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7239 extended period, use the following commands:
7242 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7243 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7244 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7245 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7246 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7247 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7248 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7249 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7250 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7254 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7257 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7258 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7259 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7260 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7262 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7263 Lift the restriction.
7266 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7267 @section The agenda dispatcher
7268 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7269 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7270 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7271 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7272 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7273 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7274 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7275 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7278 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7280 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7282 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7283 tags and properties}).
7285 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7287 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7288 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7290 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7291 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7292 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7293 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7294 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7297 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7299 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7300 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7301 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7302 selecting the command.
7304 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7305 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7306 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7307 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7308 character selecting the command.
7311 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7312 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7313 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7314 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7315 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7316 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7317 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7318 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}.
7321 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7322 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7323 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7324 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7325 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7327 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7328 @section The built-in agenda views
7330 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7333 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7334 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7335 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7336 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7337 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7338 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7341 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7342 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7344 @cindex weekly agenda
7345 @cindex daily agenda
7347 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7348 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7351 @cindex org-agenda, command
7352 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7353 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7354 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7355 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7356 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7357 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7358 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7361 @vindex org-agenda-span
7362 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7363 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7364 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7365 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7366 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7369 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7370 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7371 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7374 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7375 @cindex calendar integration
7376 @cindex diary integration
7378 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7379 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7380 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7381 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7382 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7383 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7386 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7387 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7390 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7393 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7394 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7395 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7396 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7397 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7398 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7399 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7400 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7401 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7402 between calendar and agenda.
7404 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7405 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7406 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7407 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7408 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7409 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7410 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7411 will be made in the agenda:
7414 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7416 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7418 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7419 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7422 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7423 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7424 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7426 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7427 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7428 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7429 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7430 following to one of your agenda files:
7437 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7440 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7441 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7442 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7443 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7444 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7445 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7446 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7452 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7455 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7456 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7457 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7458 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7459 in an Org or Diary file.
7461 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7462 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7463 @cindex appointment reminders
7467 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7468 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7469 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7470 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7471 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7473 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7474 @subsection The global TODO list
7475 @cindex global TODO list
7476 @cindex TODO list, global
7478 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7479 collected into a single place.
7482 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7483 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7484 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7485 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7486 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7487 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7488 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7489 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7490 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7491 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7492 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7493 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7494 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7495 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7497 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7498 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7499 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7500 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7501 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7502 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7505 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7506 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7507 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7509 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7510 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7511 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7515 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7516 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7517 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7518 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7519 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7520 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7521 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7522 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7523 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7524 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7527 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7528 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7529 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7530 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7531 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7534 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7535 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7536 @cindex matching, of tags
7537 @cindex matching, of properties
7541 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7542 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7543 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7544 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7548 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7549 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7550 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7551 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7552 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7553 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7554 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7555 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7556 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7557 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7558 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7559 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7560 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7561 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7565 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7568 @subsubheading Match syntax
7570 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7571 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7572 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7573 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7574 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7575 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7576 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7577 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7578 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7582 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7585 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7586 @item work|laptop+night
7587 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7591 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7592 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7593 braces. For example,
7594 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7595 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7597 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7598 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7599 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7600 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7601 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7602 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7603 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7604 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7605 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7606 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7607 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7608 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7609 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7610 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7611 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7612 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7614 Here are more examples:
7616 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7617 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7618 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7619 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7620 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7623 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7624 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7627 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7628 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7632 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7635 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7636 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7637 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7639 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7640 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7642 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7643 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7644 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7645 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7646 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7647 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7648 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7649 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7650 respectively, can be used.
7652 If the comparison value is enclosed
7653 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7654 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7658 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7659 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7660 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7661 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7662 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7663 on or after October 11, 2008.
7665 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7666 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7667 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7670 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7671 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7672 inheritance}, for details.
7674 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7675 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7676 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7677 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7678 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7679 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7680 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7681 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7682 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7683 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7684 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7685 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7689 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7690 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7691 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7693 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7694 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7698 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7699 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7700 @cindex timeline, single file
7701 @cindex time-sorted view
7703 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7704 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7705 to give an overview over events in a project.
7708 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7709 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7710 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7711 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7715 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7716 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7718 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7719 @subsection Search view
7722 @cindex searching, for text
7724 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7725 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7728 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7729 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7730 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7732 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7733 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7734 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7735 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7736 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7737 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7738 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7739 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7740 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7741 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7742 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7744 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7745 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7746 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7748 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7749 @subsection Stuck projects
7750 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7752 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7753 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7754 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7755 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7756 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7757 projects and define next actions for them.
7760 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7761 List projects that are stuck.
7764 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7765 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7766 project is and how to find it.
7769 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7770 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7771 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7772 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7774 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7775 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7776 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7777 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7778 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7779 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7780 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7781 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7782 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7783 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7784 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7785 correct customization for this is
7788 (setq org-stuck-projects
7789 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7793 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7794 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7796 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7797 @section Presentation and sorting
7798 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7800 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7801 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7802 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7803 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7804 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7805 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7806 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7807 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7808 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7809 associated with the item.
7812 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7813 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7814 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7817 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7818 @subsection Categories
7822 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7823 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7824 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7825 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7826 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7827 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7828 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7829 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7830 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7838 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7839 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7840 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7841 special category you want to apply as the value.
7844 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7845 longer than 10 characters.
7848 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7849 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7851 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7852 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7853 @cindex time-of-day specification
7855 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7856 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7857 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7858 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7860 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7862 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7863 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7864 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7865 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7867 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7868 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7869 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7872 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7873 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7874 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7875 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7879 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7880 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7883 8:00...... ------------------
7884 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7885 10:00...... ------------------
7886 12:00...... ------------------
7887 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7888 14:00...... ------------------
7889 16:00...... ------------------
7890 18:00...... ------------------
7891 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7892 20:00...... ------------------
7893 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7896 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7897 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7898 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7899 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7900 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7902 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7903 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7904 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7905 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7906 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7907 done depends on the type of view.
7910 @vindex org-agenda-files
7911 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7912 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7913 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7914 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7915 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7916 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7917 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7918 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7919 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7921 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7922 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7923 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7924 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7927 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7928 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7931 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7932 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7933 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7934 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7936 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7937 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7938 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7940 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7941 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7942 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7943 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7944 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7945 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7947 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7948 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7951 @tsubheading{Motion}
7952 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7953 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7954 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7955 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7956 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7957 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7958 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7959 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7960 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7961 outline, not only the heading.
7963 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7964 Display original location and recenter that window.
7966 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7967 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7969 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7970 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7972 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7973 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7974 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7975 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7976 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7977 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7978 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7980 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7981 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7982 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7983 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7984 previously used indirect buffer.
7986 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7987 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7988 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7989 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7991 @tsubheading{Change display}
7992 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7995 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
7999 Delete other windows.
8001 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8002 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8003 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8004 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8005 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8006 @vindex org-agenda-span
8007 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8008 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8009 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8010 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8011 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8012 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8013 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8014 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8015 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8016 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8017 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8019 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8020 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8021 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8022 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8024 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8025 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8027 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8030 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8031 Prompt for a date and go there.
8033 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8034 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8036 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8037 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8039 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8041 @vindex org-log-done
8042 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8043 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8044 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8045 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8046 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8047 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8048 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8049 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8050 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8052 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8053 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8054 agenda and timeline views.
8056 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8057 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8058 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8059 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8060 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8061 press @kbd{v a} again.
8063 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8064 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8065 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8066 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8067 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8068 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8069 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8070 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8071 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8072 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8073 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8074 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8077 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8078 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8079 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8080 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8081 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8082 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8085 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8086 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8087 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8088 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8089 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8090 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8091 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8092 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8094 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8095 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8096 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8097 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8098 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8100 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8101 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8102 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8103 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8104 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8106 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8109 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8110 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8113 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8114 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8115 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8116 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8117 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8118 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8119 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8120 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8122 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8123 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8124 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8126 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8127 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8128 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8129 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8130 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8131 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8133 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8134 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8136 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8137 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8138 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8141 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8142 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8143 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8144 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8145 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8146 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8147 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8148 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8149 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8150 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8151 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8153 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8154 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8155 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8156 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8157 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8158 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8159 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8160 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8161 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8162 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8164 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8165 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8166 efforts globally, for example
8168 (setq org-global-properties
8169 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8171 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8172 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8173 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8174 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8175 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8176 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8177 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8178 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8179 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8180 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8182 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8183 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8184 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8185 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8186 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8187 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8188 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8189 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8190 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8194 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8196 ((string= tag "Net")
8197 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8198 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8199 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8200 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8201 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8204 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8208 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8209 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8210 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8211 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8212 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8221 @item @r{in} search view
8222 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8223 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8224 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8225 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8226 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8230 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8231 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8236 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8237 @cindex remote editing, undo
8238 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8239 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8240 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8242 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8243 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8246 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8247 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8248 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8250 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8251 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8252 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8253 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8254 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8255 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8257 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8258 Refile the entry at point.
8260 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8261 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8262 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8263 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8264 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8266 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8267 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8269 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8270 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8273 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8274 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8275 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8278 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8279 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8280 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8281 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8282 tags of a headline occasionally.
8284 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8285 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8286 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8290 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8291 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8292 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8294 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8295 Display weighted priority of current item.
8297 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8298 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8299 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8302 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8303 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8305 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8306 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8307 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8308 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8309 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8311 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8312 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8314 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8315 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8317 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8318 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8320 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
8321 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
8322 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
8325 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
8326 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
8327 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
8328 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
8329 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
8332 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
8335 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8336 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8337 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8339 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8340 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8341 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8342 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8343 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8344 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8345 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8347 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8348 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8351 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8352 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8353 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8355 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8356 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8359 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8360 Stop the previously started clock.
8362 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8363 Cancel the currently running clock.
8365 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8366 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8368 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8369 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8370 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8371 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8373 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8374 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8377 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8378 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8380 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8381 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8383 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8384 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8386 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8387 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8388 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8389 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8390 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8391 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8392 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8395 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8396 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8397 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8398 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8399 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8400 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8401 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8402 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8403 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8404 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8405 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8406 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8407 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8408 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8409 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8410 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8411 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8413 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8414 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8415 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8416 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8417 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8418 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8419 @r{ (save-excursion}
8420 @r{ (save-restriction}
8422 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8423 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8424 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8428 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8429 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8431 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8432 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8434 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8435 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8438 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8439 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8440 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8441 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8442 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8443 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8444 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8445 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8446 you can add the entry.
8448 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8449 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8450 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8451 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8452 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8453 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8454 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8455 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8456 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8457 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8459 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8460 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8462 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8463 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8464 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8466 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8467 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8470 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8471 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8473 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8474 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8475 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8477 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8478 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8479 @cindex exporting agenda views
8480 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8481 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8482 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8483 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8484 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8485 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8486 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8487 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8488 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8490 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8491 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8492 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8494 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8495 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8496 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8497 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8498 visit Org files will not be removed.
8502 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8503 @section Custom agenda views
8504 @cindex custom agenda views
8505 @cindex agenda views, custom
8507 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8508 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8509 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8510 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8513 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8514 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8515 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8518 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8519 @subsection Storing searches
8521 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8522 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8523 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8526 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8527 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8528 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8529 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8530 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8535 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8536 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8537 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8538 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8539 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8540 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8541 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8542 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8543 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8544 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8545 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8550 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8551 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8552 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8553 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8554 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8555 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8556 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8557 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8558 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8563 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8566 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8567 results as a sparse tree
8569 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8572 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8573 headlines that are also TODO items
8575 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8576 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8578 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8579 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8581 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8582 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8583 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8586 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8587 @subsection Block agenda
8588 @cindex block agenda
8589 @cindex agenda, with block views
8591 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8592 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8593 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8594 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8595 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8596 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8597 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8601 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8602 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8606 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8614 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8615 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8616 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8617 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8618 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8620 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8621 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8622 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8624 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8625 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8626 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8627 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8628 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8629 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8630 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8634 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8635 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8636 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8637 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8638 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8639 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8640 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8642 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8643 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8648 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8649 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8650 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8651 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8652 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8653 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8654 to only a single file.
8656 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8657 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8658 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8659 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8660 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8661 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8662 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8663 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8664 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8665 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8666 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8670 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8671 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8675 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8676 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8677 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8684 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8685 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8686 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8687 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8688 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8692 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8693 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8694 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8696 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8697 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8698 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8699 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8700 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8701 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8702 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8705 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8706 @cindex exporting agenda views
8707 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8708 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8709 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8710 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8711 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8712 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8713 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8714 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8716 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8717 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8718 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8719 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8721 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8722 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8723 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8724 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8725 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8729 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8730 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8731 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8732 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8733 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8734 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8735 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8736 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8737 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8742 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8743 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8744 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8745 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8750 ("~/views/home.html"))
8751 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8756 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8760 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8761 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8762 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8763 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8764 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8765 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8766 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8767 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8769 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8770 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8771 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8775 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8776 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8780 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8781 set options for the export commands. For example:
8784 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8786 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8787 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8788 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8789 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8790 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8795 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8796 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8797 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8798 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8799 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8800 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8801 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8802 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8803 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8806 From the command line you may also use
8808 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8811 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8812 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8814 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8815 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8816 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8817 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8818 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8822 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8823 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8826 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8827 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8831 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8832 @section Using column view in the agenda
8833 @cindex column view, in agenda
8834 @cindex agenda, column view
8836 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8837 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8838 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8839 collected by certain criteria.
8842 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8843 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8846 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8847 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8848 This causes the following issues:
8852 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8853 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8854 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8855 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8856 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8857 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8858 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8859 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8860 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8861 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8863 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8864 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8865 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8866 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8867 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8868 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8869 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8870 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8871 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8872 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8873 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8874 some values will count double.
8876 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8877 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8878 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8879 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8880 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8881 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8882 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8887 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8888 @chapter Markup for rich export
8890 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8891 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8892 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8893 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8894 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
8897 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8898 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8899 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8900 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8901 * Index entries:: Making an index
8902 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8903 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8906 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8907 @section Structural markup elements
8910 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8911 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8912 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8913 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8915 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8916 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8917 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8918 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8919 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8922 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8923 @subheading Document title
8924 @cindex document title, markup rules
8927 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8931 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8935 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8936 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8937 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8938 title will be the file name without extension.
8940 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8941 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8942 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8943 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8945 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8946 @subheading Headings and sections
8947 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8949 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8950 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8951 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8952 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8953 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8954 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8955 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8956 per-file basis with a line
8963 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8964 @subheading Table of contents
8965 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8967 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8968 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8969 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8970 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8971 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8972 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8973 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8974 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8977 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8978 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8981 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8982 @subheading Text before the first headline
8983 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8986 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8987 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8988 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8989 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8991 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8992 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8993 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8994 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8995 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8996 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8999 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9000 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9004 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9005 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9006 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9009 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9011 @cindex lists, markup rules
9013 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9014 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9017 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9018 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9019 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9021 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9022 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9024 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9025 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9027 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9030 Great clouds overhead
9031 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9038 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9039 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9040 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9042 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9045 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9046 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9050 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9051 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9054 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9060 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9061 @subheading Footnote markup
9062 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9063 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9065 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9066 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9067 multiple footnotes side by side.
9069 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9070 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9072 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9073 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9074 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9075 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9076 @cindex code text, markup rules
9077 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9078 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9079 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9080 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9081 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9083 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9084 @subheading Horizontal rules
9085 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9086 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9087 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9089 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9090 @subheading Comment lines
9091 @cindex comment lines
9092 @cindex exporting, not
9093 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9095 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
9096 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
9097 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
9098 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
9099 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9104 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9108 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9109 @section Images and Tables
9111 @cindex tables, markup rules
9114 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9115 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9116 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9117 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9118 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9119 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9122 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9123 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9128 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9130 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9133 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9134 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9135 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9136 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9137 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9138 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9139 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9142 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9143 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9147 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9148 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9151 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9153 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9154 @section Literal examples
9155 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9156 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9158 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9159 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9160 for source code and similar examples.
9161 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9165 Some example from a text file.
9169 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9170 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9171 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9172 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9173 whitespace before the colon:
9177 : Some example from a text file.
9180 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9181 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9182 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9183 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9184 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9185 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9186 achieved using either the listings or the
9187 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
9188 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
9189 package is included by the @LaTeX{} header (e.g.@: by configuring
9190 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
9191 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
9192 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
9193 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
9194 package is included by the @LaTeX{} header, and ensuring that the
9195 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
9196 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
9197 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
9198 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
9199 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
9200 example@footnote{Code in @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either
9201 interactively or on export. See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more
9202 information on evaluating code blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for
9203 shortcuts to easily insert code blocks.
9207 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9208 (defun org-xor (a b)
9214 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9215 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9216 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9217 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9218 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9219 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
9220 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9221 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9224 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9225 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9226 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9227 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9228 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9229 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9233 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9234 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9235 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9237 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9241 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9242 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9243 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9244 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9246 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9247 areas in HTML export}).
9249 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9250 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9251 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9256 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9257 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9258 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
9259 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
9260 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
9261 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
9262 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
9263 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
9264 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
9265 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
9266 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
9270 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9271 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9272 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9273 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9274 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9278 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9279 @section Include files
9280 @cindex include files, markup rules
9282 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9283 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9287 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9290 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
9291 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9292 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9293 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9294 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9295 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9296 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9297 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9298 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9302 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9305 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9306 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9307 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9311 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9312 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9313 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9319 Visit the include file at point.
9322 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9323 @section Index entries
9324 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9326 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9327 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9328 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9329 an index} for more information.
9334 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9340 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9341 @section Macro replacement
9342 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9345 You can define text snippets with
9348 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9351 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9352 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9353 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9354 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9355 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9356 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9357 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9358 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9359 @code{format-time-string}.
9361 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9362 construct complex HTML code.
9365 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9366 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9367 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9368 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9370 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9371 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9372 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9373 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9374 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9375 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9376 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9377 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9378 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9381 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9382 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9383 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9384 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9385 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9388 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9389 @subsection Special symbols
9390 @cindex math symbols
9391 @cindex special symbols
9392 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9393 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9394 @cindex HTML entities
9395 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9397 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9398 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9399 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9400 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9401 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9402 delimiters, for example:
9405 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9408 @vindex org-entities
9409 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9410 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9411 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9412 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9413 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9414 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9416 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9417 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9418 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9419 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9420 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9422 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9423 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9424 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9425 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9430 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9431 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9432 for display purposes only.
9435 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9436 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9440 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9441 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9442 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9443 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9444 with curly braces. For example
9447 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9448 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9451 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9452 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9453 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9454 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9455 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9456 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9457 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9463 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9464 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9469 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9470 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9473 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9474 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9475 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9477 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9478 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9479 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9480 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9481 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9482 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9483 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9484 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9485 @file{MathJax} on your own
9486 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9487 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9488 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9489 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9490 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9491 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9492 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9493 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9496 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9497 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9500 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9501 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9502 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9503 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9504 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9506 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9507 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9508 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9509 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9510 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9511 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9512 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9515 @noindent For example:
9518 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9519 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9520 \end@{equation@} % etc
9522 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9523 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9527 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9528 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9529 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9530 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9532 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9533 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9534 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9535 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9536 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9540 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9541 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9542 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9543 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9546 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9547 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9548 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9550 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9551 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9556 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9557 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9558 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9559 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9560 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9561 process the entire buffer.
9564 Remove the overlay preview images.
9567 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9568 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9569 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9570 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9573 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9574 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9577 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9578 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9579 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9580 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9581 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9582 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9583 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9584 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9585 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9589 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9592 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9593 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9597 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9600 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9601 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9602 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9603 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9604 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9605 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9606 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9607 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9608 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9609 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9610 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9614 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9615 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9616 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9617 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9618 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9619 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9622 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9623 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9624 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9627 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9628 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9629 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9630 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9634 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9638 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9639 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9640 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9641 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9642 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9643 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9644 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9645 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9646 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9647 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9648 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9649 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9650 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9651 these different formats.
9653 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9654 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9657 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9658 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9659 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9660 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9661 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9662 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9663 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9664 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9665 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9666 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9667 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9668 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9671 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9672 @section Selective export
9673 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9675 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9676 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9677 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9678 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9679 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9680 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9681 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9685 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9686 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9687 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9688 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9691 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9695 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9696 be removed from the export buffer.
9699 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9700 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9701 variable for more information.
9703 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9704 @section Export options
9705 @cindex options, for export
9707 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9708 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9709 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9710 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9711 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9712 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9713 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9714 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9715 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9716 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9719 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9720 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9727 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9735 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9736 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9738 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9739 @vindex user-full-name
9740 @vindex user-mail-address
9741 @vindex org-export-default-language
9742 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9744 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9745 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9746 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9747 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9748 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9749 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9750 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9751 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9752 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9753 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9754 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9755 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9756 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9757 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9758 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9759 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9760 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9761 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9765 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9766 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9767 settings. Here you can:
9768 @cindex headline levels
9769 @cindex section-numbers
9770 @cindex table of contents
9771 @cindex line-break preservation
9772 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9773 @cindex fixed-width sections
9775 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9777 @cindex special strings
9778 @cindex emphasized text
9779 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9780 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9781 @cindex author info, in export
9782 @cindex time info, in export
9783 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9784 @vindex org-export-author-info
9785 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9786 @vindex org-export-email-info
9787 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9789 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9790 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9791 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9792 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9793 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9794 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9795 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9796 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9797 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9798 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9799 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9800 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9801 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9802 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9803 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9804 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9805 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9806 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9807 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9808 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9809 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9810 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9811 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9812 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9813 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9814 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9815 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9818 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9819 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9820 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9822 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9823 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9824 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9825 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9827 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9828 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9829 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9830 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9831 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9833 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9834 @section The export dispatcher
9835 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9837 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9838 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9839 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9840 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9841 the subtrees are exported.
9844 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9845 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9846 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9847 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9848 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9849 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9850 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9851 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9852 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9853 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9854 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9855 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9856 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9857 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9858 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9859 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9862 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9863 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9864 @cindex ASCII export
9865 @cindex Latin-1 export
9866 @cindex UTF-8 export
9868 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9869 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9870 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9872 @cindex region, active
9873 @cindex active region
9874 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9876 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9877 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9878 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9879 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9880 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9881 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9882 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9883 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9884 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9885 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9887 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9888 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9889 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9890 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9891 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9892 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9893 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9894 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9895 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9896 Export only the visible part of the document.
9899 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9900 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9901 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9902 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9903 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9910 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
9911 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9912 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9913 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9914 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9915 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9916 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
9918 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9919 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9920 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9921 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9923 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9924 @section HTML export
9927 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9928 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9929 language, but with additional support for tables.
9932 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9933 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
9934 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
9935 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9936 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9937 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9938 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9939 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9940 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9941 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9944 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
9945 @subsection HTML export commands
9947 @cindex region, active
9948 @cindex active region
9949 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9951 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9952 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9953 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9954 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9955 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9956 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9957 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9958 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9959 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9960 property, that name will be used for the export.
9961 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9962 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9963 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9964 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9965 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9966 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9967 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9968 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9969 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9970 Export only the visible part of the document.
9971 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9972 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
9973 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9975 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9976 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
9980 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9981 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9982 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9983 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9984 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9991 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9994 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9995 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
9996 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
9997 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
9998 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
9999 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10000 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10001 @vindex org-export-author-info
10002 @vindex org-export-email-info
10003 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10004 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10006 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10008 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10009 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10010 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10012 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10013 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10014 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10015 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10016 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10017 insert any preamble.
10019 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10020 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10021 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10022 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10023 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10024 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10025 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10026 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10027 insert any postamble.
10029 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10030 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10032 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
10033 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10034 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10035 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10036 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10037 the exported file use either
10040 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10042 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10046 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10050 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10055 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10056 @subsection Links in HTML export
10058 @cindex links, in HTML export
10059 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10060 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10061 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
10062 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10063 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10064 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10065 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10066 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10067 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10068 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10069 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10071 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10072 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10073 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10074 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10076 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10078 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10079 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10082 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10084 @cindex tables, in HTML
10085 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10087 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10088 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10089 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10090 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10093 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10095 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10096 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10099 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10100 @subsection Images in HTML export
10102 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10103 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10104 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10105 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10106 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10107 default@footnote{But see the variable
10108 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10109 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10110 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10111 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10112 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10113 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10114 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10115 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10118 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10121 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10122 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10123 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10126 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10128 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10129 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10134 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10136 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10137 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10141 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10142 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10143 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10144 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10145 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10146 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10147 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10148 found on the MathJax website, see
10149 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10150 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10151 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10152 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10155 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10158 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10159 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10162 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10163 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10164 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10165 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10166 You can still get this processing with
10169 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10172 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10173 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10175 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10176 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10177 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10178 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10179 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10180 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10181 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10182 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10183 respectively. For example
10186 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10187 (defun org-xor (a b)
10194 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10195 @subsection CSS support
10196 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10197 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10199 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10200 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10201 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10202 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10203 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10204 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10205 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10206 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10207 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10209 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10210 p.date @r{publishing date}
10211 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10212 .title @r{document title}
10213 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10214 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10215 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10216 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10217 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10218 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10219 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10220 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10221 .target @r{target for links}
10222 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10223 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10224 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10225 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10226 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10227 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10228 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10229 pre.example @r{normal example}
10230 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10231 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10232 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10233 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10234 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10237 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10238 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10239 @vindex org-export-html-style
10240 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10241 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10242 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10243 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10244 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10245 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10246 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10247 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10248 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10249 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10250 individually for each file, you can use
10254 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10258 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10259 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10260 referring to an external file.
10262 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10263 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10264 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10267 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10268 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10270 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10271 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10273 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10274 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10275 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10276 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10277 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10278 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10279 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10280 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10281 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10282 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10283 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10284 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10285 copy on your own web server.
10287 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10288 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10289 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10290 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10291 adding a single line to the Org file:
10293 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10295 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10299 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10300 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10304 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10305 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10306 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10307 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10308 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10309 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10310 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10311 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10312 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10313 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10314 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10315 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10316 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10317 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10318 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10319 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10320 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10321 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10322 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10323 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10324 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10325 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10326 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10327 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10328 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10331 @vindex org-infojs-options
10332 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10333 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10334 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10335 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10337 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10338 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10339 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10341 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10343 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10344 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10345 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10346 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10347 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10348 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10349 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10350 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10351 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10352 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10356 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10357 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10358 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10359 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10360 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10361 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10364 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10365 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10367 @cindex region, active
10368 @cindex active region
10369 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10371 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10372 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10373 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10374 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10375 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10376 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10377 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10378 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10379 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10380 property, that name will be used for the export.
10381 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10382 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10383 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10384 Export only the visible part of the document.
10385 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10386 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10387 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10389 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10390 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10392 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10393 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10394 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10395 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10398 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10399 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10400 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10401 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10402 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10403 convert them to a custom string depending on
10404 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10406 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10407 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10410 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10414 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10416 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10417 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10418 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10419 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10420 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10421 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10422 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10424 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10426 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10427 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10428 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10429 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10430 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10431 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10432 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10433 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10434 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10435 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10436 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10437 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10438 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10439 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10440 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10441 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10442 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10443 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10444 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10445 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10446 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10447 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10448 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10449 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10453 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10454 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10455 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10461 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10462 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10464 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10465 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10466 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10467 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10468 the following constructs:
10471 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10473 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10477 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10481 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10486 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10487 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10488 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10490 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10491 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10492 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10493 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10494 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10495 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10496 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10501 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10503 #+CAPTION: A long table
10505 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10510 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10514 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10516 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10518 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10523 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10524 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10525 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10526 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10528 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10529 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10530 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10531 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10532 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10533 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10534 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10535 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10536 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10537 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10538 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10539 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10540 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10541 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10542 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10543 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10545 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10546 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10547 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10548 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10549 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10550 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10554 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10556 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10557 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10558 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10559 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10561 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10565 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10566 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10567 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10569 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10570 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10572 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10573 @subsection Beamer class export
10575 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10576 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10577 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10579 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10580 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10581 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10582 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10583 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10584 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10585 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10586 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10587 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10588 structure of the presentation.
10590 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10591 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10592 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10593 editing special properties used by beamer.
10595 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10600 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10601 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10602 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10603 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10604 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10605 @item BEAMER_envargs
10606 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10607 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10608 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10609 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10610 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10613 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10614 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10615 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10616 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10617 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10618 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10619 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10620 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10622 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10623 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10627 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10628 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10629 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10630 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10631 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10632 in the presentation as well.
10634 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10635 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10636 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10637 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10638 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10639 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10640 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10642 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10650 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10651 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10652 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10655 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10656 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10657 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10658 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10660 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10663 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10664 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10665 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10666 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10667 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10668 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10669 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10671 * This is the first structural section
10673 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10674 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10677 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10680 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10681 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10685 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10687 for contributing to the discussion
10688 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10689 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10690 *** Request :B_block:
10691 Please test this stuff!
10697 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10699 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10700 @section DocBook export
10701 @cindex DocBook export
10703 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10705 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10706 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10707 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10708 tools and stylesheets.
10710 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10713 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10714 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10715 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10716 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10717 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10718 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10721 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10722 @subsection DocBook export commands
10724 @cindex region, active
10725 @cindex active region
10726 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10728 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10729 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10730 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10731 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10732 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10733 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10734 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10735 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10736 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10737 property, that name will be used for the export.
10738 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10739 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10741 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10742 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10743 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10744 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10745 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10746 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10748 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10749 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10750 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10751 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10752 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10753 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10755 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10756 Export only the visible part of the document.
10759 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10760 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10762 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10763 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10766 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10768 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10772 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10776 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10781 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10782 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10783 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10784 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10789 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10790 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10791 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10796 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10797 @subsection Recursive sections
10798 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10800 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10801 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10802 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10803 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10804 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10805 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10807 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10808 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10810 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10811 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10812 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10814 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10817 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10818 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10819 using the @code{table} element.
10821 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10822 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10823 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10824 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10826 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10827 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10828 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10829 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10830 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10831 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10832 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10833 @code{mediaobject} element.
10835 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10836 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10837 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10838 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10839 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10840 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10841 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10842 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10844 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10845 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10846 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10847 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10848 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10853 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10855 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10856 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10857 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10858 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10861 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10862 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10863 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10864 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10865 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10867 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10868 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10869 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10871 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10872 @vindex org-entities
10873 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10874 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10875 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10876 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10877 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10878 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10880 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10881 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10882 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10883 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10886 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10887 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10888 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10889 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10896 @c begin opendocument
10898 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
10899 @section OpenDocument Text export
10900 @cindex K, Jambunathan
10902 @cindex OpenDocument
10903 @cindex export, OpenDocument
10904 @cindex LibreOffice
10906 @cindex org-modules
10908 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
10909 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
10910 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
10911 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
10912 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
10913 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
10916 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
10917 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
10918 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
10919 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
10920 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10921 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
10922 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
10923 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
10924 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
10925 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
10926 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
10929 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
10930 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
10932 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
10933 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
10935 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
10936 @subsection ODT export commands
10938 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
10939 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
10941 @cindex region, active
10942 @cindex active region
10943 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10945 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
10946 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10948 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
10950 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10951 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
10952 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
10953 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
10955 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
10956 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
10957 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
10958 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
10959 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
10960 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
10961 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10964 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
10965 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
10967 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10968 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
10969 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
10970 exporting to other formats}.
10973 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
10974 @subsection Extending ODT export
10976 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
10977 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
10978 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
10979 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
10981 @cindex @file{unoconv}
10982 @cindex LibreOffice
10983 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
10984 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
10985 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
10986 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
10987 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
10988 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
10989 document converter}.
10991 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
10992 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
10994 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
10995 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
10996 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
10997 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
10998 preferred output format by customizing the variable
10999 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11000 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11001 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11003 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11004 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11006 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11007 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11008 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11009 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11010 the following command.
11012 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11015 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11016 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11017 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11020 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11021 @subsection Applying custom styles
11022 @cindex styles, custom
11023 @cindex template, custom
11025 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11026 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11027 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11028 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11029 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11030 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11031 users alike, and is described here.
11033 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
11037 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11041 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11045 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11046 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
11047 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11048 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11051 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11052 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11053 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11054 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11055 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11057 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11058 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11061 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11067 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11072 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11074 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11075 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11076 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11077 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11078 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11079 the factory settings.
11081 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11082 @subsection Links in ODT export
11083 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11085 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11086 Internet-style links for all other links.
11088 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11089 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11091 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11092 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11093 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11095 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11096 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11097 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11099 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11100 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
11101 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
11102 stripped from the exported document.
11104 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11105 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11106 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11107 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11108 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11109 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11112 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11113 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11115 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11119 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11120 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11121 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11123 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11124 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11125 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11126 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11127 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11128 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11131 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11132 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11133 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11134 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11135 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11137 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11138 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11139 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11141 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11142 @subsection Images in ODT export
11143 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11144 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11146 @subsubheading Embedding images
11147 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11148 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11149 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11159 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11160 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11161 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11162 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11163 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11166 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11169 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11172 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11173 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11175 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11176 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11177 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11178 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11179 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11180 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11181 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11182 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11183 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11184 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11185 converted in to units of centimeters using
11186 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11187 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11188 achieve the best results.
11190 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11193 @item Explicitly size the image
11194 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11197 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11201 @item Scale the image
11202 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11205 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11209 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11210 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11211 height:width ratio, do the following:
11214 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11218 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11219 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11220 height:width ratio, do the following
11223 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11228 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11231 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11232 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11233 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11234 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11236 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11238 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11242 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11243 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11245 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11248 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11249 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11252 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11253 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11255 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11256 document in one of the following ways:
11262 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11268 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11269 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11270 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11271 the exported document.
11273 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11274 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11276 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11277 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11278 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11280 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11281 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11282 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11285 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11286 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11287 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11288 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11291 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11292 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11296 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11297 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11299 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11300 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11301 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11307 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11310 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11313 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11314 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11315 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11318 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11319 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11321 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11322 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11323 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11324 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11336 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11337 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11339 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11340 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11341 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11342 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11343 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11344 appearance in the Org file.
11346 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11347 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11351 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11352 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11356 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11359 Figure 2: Bell curve
11362 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11363 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11364 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11365 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11366 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11369 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11370 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11373 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11377 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11380 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11381 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11383 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11384 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11385 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11386 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11387 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11388 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11389 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11391 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11392 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11393 by customizing the variable
11394 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11396 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11397 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11398 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11400 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11401 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11403 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11404 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11405 that would be of interest to power users.
11408 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11409 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11410 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11411 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11412 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11415 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11416 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11418 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11421 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11422 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11423 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11424 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11427 @item Register the converter
11429 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11430 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11431 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11432 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11434 @item Configure its capabilities
11436 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11437 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11438 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11439 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11440 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11441 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11442 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11443 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11445 @item Choose the converter
11447 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11448 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11449 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11452 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11453 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11454 @cindex styles, custom
11455 @cindex template, custom
11457 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11458 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11459 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11462 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11463 @subsubheading Factory styles
11465 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11466 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11467 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11470 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11472 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11474 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11475 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11479 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11482 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11486 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11488 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11490 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11491 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11492 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11494 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11495 file serves the following purposes:
11499 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11503 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11504 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11509 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11510 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11511 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11512 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11513 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11517 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11519 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11521 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11522 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11525 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11527 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11529 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11531 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11534 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11536 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11537 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11538 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11540 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11541 like header and footer images.
11545 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11548 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11550 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11552 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11553 in the final output.
11556 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11557 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11559 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11560 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11561 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11564 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11566 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11567 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11570 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11571 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11575 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11576 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11577 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11580 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11581 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11585 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11587 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11588 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11591 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11594 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11595 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11596 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11599 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11600 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11601 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11605 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11607 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11608 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11610 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11615 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11616 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11623 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11624 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11625 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11628 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11629 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11630 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11632 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11634 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11635 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11639 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11641 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11642 the table that follows.
11645 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11646 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11647 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11648 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11649 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11650 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11651 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11652 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11656 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11657 | Name | Phone | Age |
11658 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11659 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11662 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11663 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11664 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11665 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11666 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11667 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11668 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11669 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11671 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11672 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11676 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11677 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11679 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11680 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11694 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11695 template using a well-defined convention.
11697 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11698 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11699 the following table.
11701 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11702 @headitem Table cell type
11703 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11704 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11709 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11710 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11712 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11713 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11715 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11716 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11718 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11719 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11721 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11722 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11724 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11725 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11727 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11728 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11730 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11731 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11733 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11734 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11737 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11739 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11740 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11744 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11745 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11746 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11747 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11748 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11749 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11751 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11752 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11753 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11756 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11757 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11760 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11761 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11762 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11763 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11766 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11767 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11768 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11769 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11770 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11771 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11772 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11773 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11777 Associate a table with the table style
11779 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11780 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11783 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11784 | Name | Phone | Age |
11785 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11786 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11790 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11791 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11793 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11794 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11795 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11796 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11797 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11799 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11800 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11801 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11802 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11804 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11805 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11806 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11807 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11808 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11809 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11811 @c end opendocument
11813 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11814 @section TaskJuggler export
11815 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11816 @cindex Project management
11818 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11819 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11820 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11823 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11824 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11825 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11828 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11829 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11830 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11833 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11836 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11837 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11839 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11840 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11845 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11846 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11847 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11848 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11849 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11850 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11851 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11852 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11853 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11854 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11856 @subsection Resources
11858 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11859 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11860 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11861 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11862 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11863 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11864 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11865 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11866 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11867 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11868 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11869 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11870 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11872 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11873 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11876 @subsection Export of properties
11878 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
11879 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11880 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11881 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
11882 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
11883 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
11884 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
11885 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
11886 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
11888 @subsection Dependencies
11890 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
11891 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
11892 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
11893 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
11894 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
11895 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
11896 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
11897 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
11898 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
11899 examples should illustrate this:
11904 :task_id: preparation
11907 * Training material
11909 :task_id: training_material
11912 ** Markup Guidelines
11916 ** Workflow Guidelines
11923 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
11927 @subsection Reports
11929 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
11930 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
11931 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
11932 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
11933 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
11934 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
11935 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
11936 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
11938 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
11939 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
11941 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
11942 @section Freemind export
11943 @cindex Freemind export
11946 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
11949 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
11950 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
11951 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
11954 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
11955 @section XOXO export
11956 @cindex XOXO export
11958 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
11959 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
11960 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
11963 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
11964 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
11965 @file{myfile.html}.
11966 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
11967 Export only the visible part of the document.
11970 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
11971 @section iCalendar export
11972 @cindex iCalendar export
11974 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
11975 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
11976 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
11977 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
11978 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
11979 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
11980 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
11981 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
11982 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
11983 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
11984 included in the export, configure the variable
11985 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
11986 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
11987 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
11988 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
11989 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
11990 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
11991 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
11992 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
11993 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
11996 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
11997 @cindex property, ID
11998 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
11999 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12000 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12001 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12002 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12003 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12004 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12005 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12006 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12009 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12010 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12011 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12012 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12013 @vindex org-agenda-files
12014 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12015 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12016 file will be written.
12017 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12018 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12019 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12020 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12021 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12024 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12025 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12026 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12027 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12028 @cindex property, LOCATION
12029 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12030 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12031 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12032 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12033 and the description from the body (limited to
12034 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12036 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12037 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12039 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12040 @chapter Publishing
12043 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12044 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12045 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12046 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12049 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12050 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12052 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12055 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12056 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12057 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12058 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12061 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12062 @section Configuration
12064 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12065 and many other properties of a project.
12068 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12069 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12070 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12071 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12072 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12073 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12074 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12075 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12078 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12079 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12080 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12081 @cindex projects, for publishing
12083 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12084 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12085 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12086 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12089 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12090 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12092 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12096 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12097 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12098 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12099 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12100 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12101 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12102 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12105 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12106 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12107 @cindex directories, for publishing
12109 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12110 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12111 and where to put published files.
12113 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12114 @item @code{:base-directory}
12115 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12116 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12117 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12118 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12119 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12120 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12121 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12122 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12123 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12124 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12125 variable @code{project-plist}.
12126 @item @code{:completion-function}
12127 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12128 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12129 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12130 @code{project-plist}.
12134 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12135 @subsection Selecting files
12136 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12138 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12139 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12141 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12142 @item @code{:base-extension}
12143 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12144 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12145 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12147 @item @code{:exclude}
12148 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12149 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12152 @item @code{:include}
12153 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12154 and @code{:exclude}.
12156 @item @code{:recursive}
12157 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12160 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12161 @subsection Publishing action
12162 @cindex action, for publishing
12164 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12165 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12166 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12167 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12168 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12169 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12170 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12171 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12172 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12173 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12174 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12175 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12176 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12177 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12178 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12179 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12180 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12181 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12182 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12184 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12185 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12186 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12187 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12188 @item @code{:plain-source}
12189 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12190 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12191 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12194 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12195 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12196 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12197 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12198 and place the result into the destination folder.
12200 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12201 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12202 @cindex options, for publishing
12204 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12205 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12206 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12207 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12208 respective variable for details.
12210 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12211 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12212 @vindex org-export-default-language
12213 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12214 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12215 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12216 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12217 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12218 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12219 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12220 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12221 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12222 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12223 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12224 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12225 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12226 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12227 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12228 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12229 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12230 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12231 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12232 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12233 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12234 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12235 @vindex org-export-author-info
12236 @vindex org-export-email-info
12237 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12238 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12239 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12240 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12241 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12242 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12243 @vindex org-export-html-style
12244 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12245 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12246 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12247 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12248 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12249 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12250 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12251 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12252 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12253 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12254 @vindex user-full-name
12255 @vindex user-mail-address
12256 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12257 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12259 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12260 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12261 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12262 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12263 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12264 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12265 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12266 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12267 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12268 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12269 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12270 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12271 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12272 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12273 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12274 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12275 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12276 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12277 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12278 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12279 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12280 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12281 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12282 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12283 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12284 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12285 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12286 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12287 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12288 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12289 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12290 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12291 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12292 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12293 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12294 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12295 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12296 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12297 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12298 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12299 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12300 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12301 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12302 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12303 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12304 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12305 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12306 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12307 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12308 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12311 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12312 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12313 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12314 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12319 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12320 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12321 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12322 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12323 options}), however, override everything.
12325 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12326 @subsection Links between published files
12327 @cindex links, publishing
12329 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12330 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12331 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12332 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12333 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12334 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12335 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12336 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12339 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12340 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12341 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12342 an example of this usage.
12344 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12345 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12346 location. In this case, use the property
12348 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12349 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12350 @tab Function to validate links
12354 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12355 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12356 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12357 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12358 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12359 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12360 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12362 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12363 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12364 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12366 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12367 a map of files for a given project.
12369 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12370 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12371 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12372 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12374 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12375 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12376 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12378 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12379 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12381 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12382 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12383 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12384 of links to all files in the project.
12386 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12387 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12388 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12389 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12391 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12392 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12393 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12394 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12395 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12396 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12397 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12399 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12400 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12402 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12403 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12404 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12405 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12406 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12407 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12408 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12410 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12411 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12412 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12413 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12415 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12416 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12417 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12418 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12422 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12423 @subsection Generating an index
12424 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12426 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12428 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12429 @item @code{:makeindex}
12430 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12431 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12434 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12435 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12436 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12437 a title, style information, etc.
12439 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12440 @section Uploading files
12444 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12445 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12446 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12447 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12448 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12451 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12452 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12453 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12454 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12455 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12457 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12458 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12459 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12460 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12461 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12462 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12465 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12466 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12467 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12468 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12469 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12470 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12472 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12473 @section Sample configuration
12475 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12476 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12477 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12480 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12481 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12484 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12485 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12487 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12488 directory on the local machine.
12491 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12493 :base-directory "~/org/"
12494 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12495 :section-numbers nil
12496 :table-of-contents nil
12497 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12498 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12499 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12502 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12503 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12505 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12506 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12507 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12510 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12511 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12512 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12513 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12516 file:../images/myimage.png
12519 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12520 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12521 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12524 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12526 :base-directory "~/org/"
12527 :base-extension "org"
12528 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12529 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12530 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12532 :section-numbers nil
12533 :table-of-contents nil
12534 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12535 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12539 :base-directory "~/images/"
12540 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12541 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12542 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12545 :base-directory "~/other/"
12546 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12547 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12548 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12549 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12552 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12553 @section Triggering publication
12555 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12558 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12559 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12560 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12561 Publish the project containing the current file.
12562 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12563 Publish only the current file.
12564 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12565 Publish every project.
12568 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12569 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12570 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12571 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12572 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12573 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12574 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12576 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12577 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12579 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12580 @chapter Working with source code
12581 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12582 @cindex Davison, Dan
12583 @cindex source code, working with
12585 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12589 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12590 (defun org-xor (a b)
12596 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12597 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12598 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12599 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12600 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12601 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12603 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12606 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12607 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12608 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12609 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12610 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12611 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12612 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12613 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12614 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12615 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12616 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12617 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12620 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12621 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12623 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12624 @section Structure of code blocks
12625 @cindex code block, structure
12626 @cindex source code, block structure
12628 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12630 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12631 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12632 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12636 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12641 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12642 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12643 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12644 @cindex source code, inline
12646 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12649 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12655 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12659 @item <#+NAME: name>
12660 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12661 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12662 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12663 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12664 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12665 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12669 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12670 @cindex source code, language
12672 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12673 @ref{Literal examples})
12674 @cindex source code, switches
12675 @item <header arguments>
12676 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12677 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12678 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12679 basis using properties.
12680 @item source code, header arguments
12682 Source code in the specified language.
12685 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12686 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12688 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12689 @section Editing source code
12690 @cindex code block, editing
12691 @cindex source code, editing
12694 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12695 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12696 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12697 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12699 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12700 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12701 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12702 further configuration options.
12705 @item org-src-lang-modes
12706 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12707 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12708 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12709 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12710 @item org-src-window-setup
12711 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12712 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12713 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12714 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12715 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12716 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12717 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12720 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12721 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12723 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12724 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12726 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12727 @section Exporting code blocks
12728 @cindex code block, exporting
12729 @cindex source code, exporting
12731 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12732 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12733 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12734 However, for some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12735 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12736 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12738 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12741 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12743 @item :exports code
12744 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12745 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12746 @item :exports results
12747 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12748 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12749 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12750 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12751 block will not be exported.
12752 @item :exports both
12753 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12754 @item :exports none
12755 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12758 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12759 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12760 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12761 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12762 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12763 markup language for a wiki.
12765 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12766 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12767 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12768 @section Extracting source code
12770 @cindex source code, extracting
12771 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12773 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12774 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12775 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12776 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12777 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12779 @subsubheading Header arguments
12782 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12784 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12785 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12786 for the block language.
12787 @item :tangle filename
12788 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12792 @subsubheading Functions
12794 @item org-babel-tangle
12795 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12796 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12797 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12800 @subsubheading Hooks
12802 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12803 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12804 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12805 of tangled code files.
12808 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12809 @section Evaluating code blocks
12810 @cindex code block, evaluating
12811 @cindex source code, evaluating
12814 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12815 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12816 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12817 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12818 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12819 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12820 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12821 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12822 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12823 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12825 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12826 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12827 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12828 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12829 used to define a code block).
12832 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12833 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12834 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12835 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12836 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12837 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12840 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12841 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12842 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12843 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12844 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12846 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12849 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12850 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12853 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12856 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12857 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12862 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12864 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12865 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12866 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12867 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12868 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12869 @item <inside header arguments>
12870 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12871 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12872 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12873 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12874 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12875 @item <end header arguments>
12876 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12877 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12878 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12879 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12880 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12882 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
12883 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
12886 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
12887 @section Library of Babel
12888 @cindex babel, library of
12889 @cindex source code, library
12890 @cindex code block, library
12892 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
12893 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
12894 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
12895 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
12898 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
12899 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
12901 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
12902 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
12903 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
12907 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
12908 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
12911 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
12913 @cindex babel, languages
12914 @cindex source code, languages
12915 @cindex code block, languages
12917 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
12919 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
12920 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
12921 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
12922 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
12923 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
12924 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
12925 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
12926 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
12927 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
12928 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
12929 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
12930 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
12931 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
12932 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
12933 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
12934 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
12935 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
12936 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
12937 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
12938 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
12941 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
12942 available, it can be found at
12943 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
12945 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
12946 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
12947 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
12948 to your emacs configuration.
12951 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
12952 @code{R} code blocks.
12956 (org-babel-do-load-languages
12957 'org-babel-load-languages
12958 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
12962 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
12963 elisp file with @code{require}.
12966 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
12970 (require 'ob-clojure)
12973 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
12974 @section Header arguments
12975 @cindex code block, header arguments
12976 @cindex source code, block header arguments
12978 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
12979 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
12980 describes each header argument in detail.
12983 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
12984 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
12987 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
12988 @subsection Using header arguments
12990 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
12991 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
12993 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
12994 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
12995 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
12996 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
12997 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
12998 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13002 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13003 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13004 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13005 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13006 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13010 :results => "replace"
13017 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13019 @c ((:session . "none")
13020 @c (:results . "replace")
13021 @c (:exports . "code")
13023 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13027 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13030 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13031 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13032 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13036 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13037 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13038 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13041 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13042 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13043 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13044 language-specific documentation available online at
13045 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13047 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13048 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13049 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13050 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13051 @ref{Property syntax}).
13053 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13054 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13055 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13056 inserted into the buffer.
13059 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13060 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13063 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13064 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13066 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13067 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13068 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13071 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13074 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13075 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13076 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13077 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13078 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13079 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13089 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13090 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13091 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13092 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13093 in Org mode documents.
13095 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13096 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13098 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13099 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13100 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13101 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13102 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13103 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13104 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13105 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13106 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13107 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13111 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13113 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13116 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13119 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13122 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13123 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13124 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13128 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13130 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13131 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13132 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13139 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13141 #+NAME: named-block
13142 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13143 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13144 (message "data:%S" data)
13147 #+RESULTS: named-block
13151 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13152 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13153 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13155 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13156 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13157 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13160 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13161 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13163 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13166 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13167 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13169 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13172 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13173 @subsection Specific header arguments
13174 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13175 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13178 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13179 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13180 be collected and handled
13181 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13182 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13183 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13184 directory for code block execution
13185 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13186 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13187 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13188 files during tangling
13189 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13191 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13193 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13194 expansion during tangling
13195 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13196 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13197 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13198 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13199 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13200 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13201 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13202 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13203 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13204 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13205 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13206 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13209 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13212 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13213 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13214 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13215 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13216 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13217 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13218 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13220 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13221 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13222 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13223 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13224 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13227 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13228 Indexable variable values}).
13230 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13231 @code{:var} header argument.
13237 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13238 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13239 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13240 results of evaluating another code block.
13242 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13247 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13249 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13255 #+NAME: table-length
13256 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13260 #+RESULTS: table-length
13265 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13266 carried through to the source code block)
13269 #+NAME: example-list
13275 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13283 @item code block without arguments
13284 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13285 optionally followed by parentheses
13288 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13296 @item code block with arguments
13297 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13298 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13299 code block name using standard function call syntax
13303 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13311 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13319 @item literal example
13320 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13323 #+NAME: literal-example
13329 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13330 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13331 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13334 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13335 : A literal example
13336 : on two lines for you.
13342 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13343 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13344 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13345 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13346 following the source name.
13349 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13350 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13355 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13356 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13357 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13358 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13359 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13360 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13361 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13362 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13363 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13366 #+NAME: example-table
13372 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13380 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13381 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13382 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13386 #+NAME: example-table
13393 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13403 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13404 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13405 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13406 column is referenced.
13409 #+NAME: example-table
13415 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13423 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13424 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13425 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13429 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13430 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13431 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13432 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13435 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13443 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13445 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13446 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13447 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13448 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13449 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13450 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13451 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13452 evaluation of the code block body.
13455 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13460 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13461 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13467 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13476 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13477 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13479 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13480 per class may be supplied per code block.
13484 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13485 from the code block
13487 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13488 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13491 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13492 block should be handled.
13495 @subsubheading Collection
13496 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13497 should be collected from the code block.
13501 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13502 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13503 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13504 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13505 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13506 @item @code{output}
13507 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13508 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13509 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13512 @subsubheading Type
13514 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13515 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13516 table or scalar depending on their value.
13519 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13520 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13521 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13522 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13524 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13525 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13526 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13527 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13528 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13529 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13531 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13532 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13533 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
13534 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13535 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13536 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13538 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13539 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13541 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13542 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13544 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13545 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13547 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13548 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13549 @code{:results value pp}.
13551 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13552 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13553 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13556 @subsubheading Handling
13557 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13558 results once they are collected.
13561 @item @code{silent}
13562 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13563 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13564 @item @code{replace}
13565 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13566 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13567 @code{:results output replace}.
13568 @item @code{append}
13569 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13570 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13571 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13572 @item @code{prepend}
13573 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13574 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13575 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13578 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13579 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13581 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13582 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13583 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13584 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13585 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13586 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13587 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13588 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13590 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13591 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13592 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13594 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13595 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13597 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13598 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13599 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13600 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13601 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13603 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13604 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13606 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13607 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13608 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13609 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13610 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13611 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13612 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13614 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13615 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13616 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13618 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13619 in your home directory, you could use
13622 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13623 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13627 @subsubheading Remote execution
13628 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13629 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13632 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13633 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13637 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13638 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13639 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13642 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13643 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13646 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13649 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13650 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13651 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13652 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13654 @subsubheading Further points
13658 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13659 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13660 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13662 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13663 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13664 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13665 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13666 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13667 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13668 which the link does not point.
13671 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13672 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13674 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13675 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13679 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13680 @code{:exports code}.
13681 @item @code{results}
13682 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13683 @code{:exports results}.
13685 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13686 @code{:exports both}.
13688 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13691 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13692 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13694 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13695 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13698 @item @code{tangle}
13699 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13700 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13701 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13703 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13704 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13706 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13707 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13708 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13711 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13712 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13714 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13715 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13716 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13718 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13719 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13720 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13721 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13722 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13723 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13727 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13729 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13730 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13732 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13734 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13736 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13737 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13739 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13741 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13742 references in the code block body in link comments.
13745 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13746 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13747 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13748 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13749 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13754 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13756 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13759 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13760 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13762 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13763 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13764 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13765 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13766 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13768 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13769 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13771 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13772 language where state is preserved.
13774 By default, a session is not started.
13776 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13777 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13778 interpreted language.
13780 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13781 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13783 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13784 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13785 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13786 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13787 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13791 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13792 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13794 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13795 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13796 @item @code{tangle}
13797 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13798 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13799 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13800 @item @code{no-export}
13801 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13802 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13803 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13804 @item @code{strip-export}
13805 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13806 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13807 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13809 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13810 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13813 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13814 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13815 @code{<<reference>>}.
13816 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13817 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13818 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13831 -- multi-line body of example
13834 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13835 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13838 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13839 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13840 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13841 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13842 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13843 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13845 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13846 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13847 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13848 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13849 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13853 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13856 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13858 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13861 ** query all mounted disks
13866 ** strip the header row
13871 ** sort by the percent full
13873 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13876 ** extract the mount point
13878 |awk '@{print $2@}'
13882 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
13883 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
13886 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
13887 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
13889 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
13890 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
13893 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
13894 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
13896 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
13897 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
13898 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
13899 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
13900 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
13901 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
13902 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
13906 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
13907 every time it is called.
13909 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
13910 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
13911 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
13912 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
13913 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
13916 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
13917 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
13918 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
13919 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
13920 changed since it was last run.
13924 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
13928 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
13932 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
13936 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
13940 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
13941 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
13943 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
13944 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
13945 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
13946 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
13947 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
13950 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
13953 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
13954 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
13956 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
13957 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
13958 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
13962 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
13963 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
13964 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
13965 default value yields the following results.
13968 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
13976 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
13980 #+RESULTS: echo-table
13987 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
13990 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
13998 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14002 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14011 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14012 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14014 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14015 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14016 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14017 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14018 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14019 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14023 If an input table looks like it has column names
14024 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14025 names will be removed from the table before
14026 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14029 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14035 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14036 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14037 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14040 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14047 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14048 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14051 No column name pre-processing takes place
14054 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14055 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
14059 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14060 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14062 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14063 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14067 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14070 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14071 and is then reapplied to the results.
14074 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14075 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14076 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14078 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14079 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14080 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14083 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14084 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14085 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14088 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14089 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14093 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14094 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14096 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14097 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14098 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14099 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14101 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14102 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14103 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14104 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14105 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14106 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14107 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14108 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14112 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14114 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14115 @item never-export or no-export
14116 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14119 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14122 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14123 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14126 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14127 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14128 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14129 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14130 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14131 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14132 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14134 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14135 @section Results of evaluation
14136 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14137 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14139 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14140 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14141 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14142 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14144 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14145 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14146 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14147 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14150 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14151 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14152 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14154 @subsection Non-session
14155 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14156 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14157 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14158 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14159 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14160 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14161 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14163 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14164 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14166 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14167 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14168 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14169 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14172 @subsection Session
14173 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14174 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14175 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14176 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14177 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14178 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14179 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14180 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14182 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14183 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14184 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14185 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14188 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14189 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14190 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14191 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14192 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14193 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14194 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14197 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14208 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14210 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14222 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14223 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14226 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14227 @section Noweb reference syntax
14228 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14229 @cindex syntax, noweb
14230 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14232 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14233 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14234 familiar Noweb syntax:
14237 <<code-block-name>>
14240 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14241 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14242 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14243 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14244 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14245 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14247 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14248 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14249 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14252 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14255 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14256 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14257 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14258 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14261 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14262 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14263 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14264 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14267 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14268 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14269 @cindex code block, key bindings
14271 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14274 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14277 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14279 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14281 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14283 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14285 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14288 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14290 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14292 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14293 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14295 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14296 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14298 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14299 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14301 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14302 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14304 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14305 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14307 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14308 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14310 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14311 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14313 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14314 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14316 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14317 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14319 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14320 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14322 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14323 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14325 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14326 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14328 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14329 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14331 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14332 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14334 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14335 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14337 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14338 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14340 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14341 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14343 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14344 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14346 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14347 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14349 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14350 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14352 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14353 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14355 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14356 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14359 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14360 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14362 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14363 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14364 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14365 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14366 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14367 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14368 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14369 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14370 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14373 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14374 @section Batch execution
14375 @cindex code block, batch execution
14376 @cindex source code, batch execution
14378 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14379 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14381 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14385 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14387 # tangle files with org-mode
14391 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
14393 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14395 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14398 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
14400 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14401 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
14402 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14403 (mapc (lambda (file)
14404 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14406 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14409 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14410 @chapter Miscellaneous
14413 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14414 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14415 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14416 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14417 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14418 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14419 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14420 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14421 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14422 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14423 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14427 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14428 @section Completion
14429 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14430 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14431 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14432 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14433 @cindex completion, of tags
14434 @cindex completion, of property keys
14435 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14436 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14437 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14438 @cindex dictionary word completion
14439 @cindex option keyword completion
14440 @cindex tag completion
14441 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14443 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14444 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14445 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14446 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14447 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14449 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14450 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14451 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14454 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14456 Complete word at point
14459 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14461 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14463 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14464 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14466 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14467 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14468 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14469 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14471 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14472 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14475 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14477 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14478 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14479 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14480 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14482 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14483 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
14485 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14489 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14490 @section Easy Templates
14491 @cindex template insertion
14492 @cindex insertion, of templates
14494 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14495 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14496 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14497 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14498 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14500 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14501 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14502 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14504 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14506 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14507 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14508 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14509 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14510 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14511 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14512 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14513 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14514 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14515 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14516 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14517 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14518 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14519 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14522 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14523 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14525 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14526 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14527 additional details.
14529 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14530 @section Speed keys
14532 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14533 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14535 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14536 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
14537 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14538 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14539 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14540 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14541 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14542 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14544 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14545 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14547 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14548 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14550 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14552 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14553 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14554 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14555 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14556 these precautions intact.
14558 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14559 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14560 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14562 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14565 @item Source code blocks
14566 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14567 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14568 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14569 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14570 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14572 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14573 which take off the default security brakes.
14575 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14576 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14577 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14578 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14579 ask and nil not to ask.
14582 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14585 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14586 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14587 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14590 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14591 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14592 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14595 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14596 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14598 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14599 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14602 @item Formulas in tables
14603 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14604 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14607 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14608 @section Customization
14609 @cindex customization
14610 @cindex options, for customization
14611 @cindex variables, for customization
14613 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14614 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14615 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14616 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14617 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14618 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14619 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14621 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14622 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14623 @cindex in-buffer settings
14624 @cindex special keywords
14626 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14627 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14628 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14629 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14630 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14631 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14632 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14633 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14634 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14636 @vindex org-archive-location
14638 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14639 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14640 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14641 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14642 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14644 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14645 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14646 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14647 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14648 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14649 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14650 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14652 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14653 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14654 @vindex org-table-formula
14655 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14656 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14657 The global version of this variable is
14658 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14659 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14660 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14662 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14663 @vindex org-drawers
14664 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14665 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14666 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14667 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14668 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14669 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14670 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14671 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14672 @vindex org-highest-priority
14673 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14674 @vindex org-default-priority
14675 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14676 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14677 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14678 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14679 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14680 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14681 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14682 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14683 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14684 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14685 (i.e.@: when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14686 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14687 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14688 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14689 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14692 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14693 Org file is being visited.
14695 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14696 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14697 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14699 @vindex org-startup-folded
14700 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14701 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14702 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14703 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14705 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14706 content @r{all headlines}
14707 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14708 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14711 @vindex org-startup-indented
14712 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14713 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14714 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14715 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14717 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14718 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14721 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14722 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14723 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14724 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14726 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14727 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14729 align @r{align all tables}
14730 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14733 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14734 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14735 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14736 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14737 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14738 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14740 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14741 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14744 @vindex org-log-done
14745 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14746 @vindex org-log-repeat
14747 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14748 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14749 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14750 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14751 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14752 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14753 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14754 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14755 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14756 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14757 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14758 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14759 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14760 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14761 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14762 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14763 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14764 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14765 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14766 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14768 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14769 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14770 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14771 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14772 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14773 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14774 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14775 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14776 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14777 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14778 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14779 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14780 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14781 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14782 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14783 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14784 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14786 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14787 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14788 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14789 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14790 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14791 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14792 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14793 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14794 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14795 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14797 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14798 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14799 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14800 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14801 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14802 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14804 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14805 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14806 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14807 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14808 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14809 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14811 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14813 @vindex constants-unit-system
14814 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14815 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14816 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14817 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14819 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14820 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14822 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14823 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14824 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14825 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14826 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14827 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14828 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14829 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14830 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14831 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14832 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14833 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14834 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14835 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14836 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14838 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14839 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14840 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14841 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14842 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14843 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14844 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14845 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14846 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14848 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14849 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14850 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14851 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14852 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14854 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14855 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14857 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14858 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14859 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14860 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14861 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14863 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14864 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14866 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14867 @vindex org-tag-alist
14868 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14869 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14870 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14872 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14873 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14874 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14875 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
14876 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
14877 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
14878 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
14879 @ref{Export options}.
14880 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
14881 @vindex org-todo-keywords
14882 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
14883 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
14886 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
14887 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
14889 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
14891 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
14892 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
14893 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
14894 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
14895 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
14896 what this means in different contexts.
14900 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
14901 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
14903 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
14904 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
14907 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
14908 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
14910 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
14913 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
14914 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
14917 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
14918 corresponding links in this buffer.
14920 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
14921 drawer, offer property commands.
14923 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
14924 definition, and vice versa.
14926 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
14928 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
14931 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
14934 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
14937 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
14940 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
14941 @section A cleaner outline view
14942 @cindex hiding leading stars
14943 @cindex dynamic indentation
14944 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
14945 @cindex clean outline view
14947 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
14948 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
14949 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
14950 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
14951 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
14955 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
14956 ** Second level | * Second level
14957 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
14958 some text | some text
14959 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
14960 more text | more text
14961 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
14967 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
14968 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
14969 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
14970 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
14971 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
14972 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
14973 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
14974 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
14975 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
14976 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
14977 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
14978 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
14979 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
14980 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
14981 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
14982 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
14983 individual files using
14989 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
14990 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
14991 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
14996 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
14997 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
14998 with the headline, like
15002 more text, now indented
15005 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15006 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15007 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15008 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15011 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15012 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15013 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15014 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15018 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15019 #+STARTUP: showstars
15022 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15026 * Top level headline
15034 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15035 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15036 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15037 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15038 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15039 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15040 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15043 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15044 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15045 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15046 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15047 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
15048 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15049 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15050 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15051 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15058 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15059 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15060 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15061 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15064 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15065 @section Using Org on a tty
15066 @cindex tty key bindings
15068 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15069 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15070 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15071 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15072 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15073 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15074 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15075 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15076 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15077 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15078 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15080 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15081 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15082 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15083 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15084 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15085 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15086 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15087 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15088 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15089 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15090 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15091 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15092 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15093 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15094 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15095 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15096 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15097 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15098 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15099 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15103 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15104 @section Interaction with other packages
15105 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15106 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15107 with other code out there.
15110 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15111 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15114 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15115 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15118 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15119 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15120 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15121 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15122 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15123 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15124 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15125 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15126 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15127 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15128 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15129 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15130 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15131 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15132 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15133 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15134 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15135 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15136 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15137 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15138 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15139 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15140 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15141 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15142 @file{constants.el}.
15143 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15144 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15145 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15146 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15147 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15148 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15149 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15150 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15151 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15153 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15154 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15156 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15157 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15158 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15159 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15160 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15161 @cindex Wiegley, John
15162 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15163 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15164 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15165 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15166 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15167 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15168 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15169 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15170 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15171 @cindex @file{table.el}
15172 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15174 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15175 @cindex @file{table.el}
15176 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15178 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15179 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15180 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15181 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15182 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15183 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15184 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15187 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15188 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15190 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15191 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15192 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15193 format. See the documentation string of the command
15194 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15197 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15198 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15199 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15200 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15201 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15202 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15203 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15206 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15207 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15211 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15212 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15213 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15214 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15215 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15216 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15217 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15218 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15219 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15220 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15221 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15222 cursor moves across a special context.
15224 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15225 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15226 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15227 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15228 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15229 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15230 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15231 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15232 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15233 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15234 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15235 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15236 buffer (but not during date selection).
15239 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15240 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15241 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15244 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15245 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15246 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15247 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15249 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15250 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15251 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15252 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15253 fixed this problem:
15256 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15258 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15259 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15262 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15263 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15267 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15268 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15271 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15274 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15276 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15277 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15278 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15279 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15282 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15283 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15284 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15285 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15286 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15287 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15291 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15292 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15293 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15294 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15295 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15298 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15299 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15301 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15302 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15303 another key for this command, or override the key in
15304 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15307 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15312 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15313 @section org-crypt.el
15314 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15315 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15317 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15318 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15321 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15322 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15323 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15325 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15329 (require 'org-crypt)
15330 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15331 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15333 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15334 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15335 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15337 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15338 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15339 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15340 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15343 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15345 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15348 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15349 being encrypted again.
15351 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15355 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15359 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15360 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15361 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15362 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15363 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15364 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15365 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15366 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15367 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15368 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15371 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15375 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15376 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15377 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15378 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15379 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15381 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15382 @section Add-on packages
15383 @cindex add-on packages
15385 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15386 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15387 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15388 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15389 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15390 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15394 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15395 @section Adding hyperlink types
15396 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15398 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15399 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15400 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15401 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15402 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15406 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15410 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15411 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15413 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15414 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15416 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15418 (defun org-man-open (path)
15419 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15420 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15421 (funcall org-man-command path))
15423 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15424 "Store a link to a manpage."
15425 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15426 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15427 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15428 (link (concat "man:" page))
15429 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15430 (org-store-link-props
15433 :description description))))
15435 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15436 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15437 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15438 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15439 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15440 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15444 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15448 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15455 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15458 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15461 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15462 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15463 that will be called to follow such a link.
15465 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15466 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15467 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15468 buffer displaying a man page.
15471 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15472 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15473 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15474 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15475 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15476 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15477 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15479 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15480 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15481 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15482 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15483 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15484 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15485 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15486 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15487 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15488 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15489 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15490 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15492 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15493 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
15494 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15495 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15497 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15498 @section Context-sensitive commands
15499 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15500 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15501 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15503 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15504 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15505 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15507 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15508 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15509 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15510 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15511 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15512 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15513 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15517 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15518 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15519 (if (save-excursion
15520 (beginning-of-line 1)
15521 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15522 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15523 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15524 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15526 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15529 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15530 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15531 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15532 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15533 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15536 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15537 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15538 @cindex tables, in other modes
15539 @cindex lists, in other modes
15540 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15542 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15543 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15544 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15545 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15546 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15549 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15550 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15551 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15552 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15553 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15554 for a very flexible system.
15556 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15557 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15558 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15559 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15563 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15564 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15565 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15566 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15569 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15570 @subsection Radio tables
15571 @cindex radio tables
15573 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15574 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15575 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15576 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15579 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15580 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15584 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15585 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15589 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15593 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15594 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15595 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15596 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15597 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15598 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15599 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15603 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15606 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15607 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15608 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15609 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15610 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15611 additional columns.
15614 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15615 the table. The default value is nil.
15619 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15620 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15621 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15622 number of different solutions:
15626 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15627 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15628 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15630 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15631 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15634 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15635 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15636 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15637 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15641 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15642 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15643 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15645 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15646 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15647 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15648 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15649 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15650 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15651 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15652 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15653 will then get the following template:
15655 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15657 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15658 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15660 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15666 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15667 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15668 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15669 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15670 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15671 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15672 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15673 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15674 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15675 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15676 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15677 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15680 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15681 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15683 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15684 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15685 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15686 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15687 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15688 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15689 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15690 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15695 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15696 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15698 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15699 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
15700 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15701 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
15702 header and footer commands of the target table:
15705 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15706 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15707 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15708 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15712 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15713 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15714 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15715 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15716 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15717 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15718 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15722 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15723 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15724 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15725 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15728 @item :splice nil/t
15729 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15730 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15733 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15734 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15735 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15736 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15737 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15738 function must return a formatted string.
15741 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15742 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15743 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15744 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15745 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15746 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15747 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15748 supplied instead of strings.
15751 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15752 @subsection Translator functions
15753 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15754 @cindex translator function
15756 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15757 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15758 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15759 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15760 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15761 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15762 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15763 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15764 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15768 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15769 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15770 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15771 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15774 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15775 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15776 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15777 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15778 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15782 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15783 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15784 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
15785 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15786 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15787 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15788 overrule the default with
15791 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15794 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15795 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15796 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15797 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15798 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15799 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15803 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15804 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15808 Please check the documentation string of the function
15809 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15810 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15811 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15812 using the generic function.
15814 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15815 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15816 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15817 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15818 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15819 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15820 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15821 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15822 others can benefit from your work.
15824 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15825 @subsection Radio lists
15826 @cindex radio lists
15827 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15829 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15830 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15831 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15832 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15834 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15838 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15840 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15842 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15845 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15848 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15853 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15854 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15856 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15865 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15866 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
15868 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
15869 @section Dynamic blocks
15870 @cindex dynamic blocks
15872 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
15873 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
15874 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
15875 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
15877 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
15878 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
15879 the content of the block.
15881 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
15883 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
15888 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
15891 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
15892 Update dynamic block at point.
15893 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
15894 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
15897 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
15898 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
15899 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
15900 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
15901 extra parameter @code{:content}.
15903 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
15904 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
15905 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
15906 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
15910 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
15916 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
15919 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
15920 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
15921 (insert "Last block update at: "
15922 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
15925 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
15926 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
15927 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
15928 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
15931 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
15932 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
15934 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
15935 @section Special agenda views
15936 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
15938 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15939 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
15940 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
15941 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
15942 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
15943 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
15944 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
15945 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
15946 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
15947 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
15948 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
15950 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
15951 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
15952 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
15953 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
15954 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
15955 the subtree belonging to the project line.
15957 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
15958 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
15959 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
15960 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
15961 search should continue from there.
15964 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
15965 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
15966 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
15967 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
15968 nil ; tag found, do not skip
15969 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
15972 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
15976 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
15977 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
15978 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
15979 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
15982 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
15983 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
15984 meaningful header in the agenda view.
15986 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15987 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15988 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
15989 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
15990 your custom search function, simply do a search for
15991 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
15992 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
15993 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
15994 you really want to have.
15996 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
15997 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
15998 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16001 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16002 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16003 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16004 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16005 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16006 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16007 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16008 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16009 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16010 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16011 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16012 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16013 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16014 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16015 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16016 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16017 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16018 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16019 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16020 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16021 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16024 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16025 like this, even without defining a special function:
16028 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16029 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16030 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16031 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16032 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16035 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16036 @section Extracting agenda information
16037 @cindex agenda, pipe
16038 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16040 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16041 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16042 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16043 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16044 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16045 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16046 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16047 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16048 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16049 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16050 current TODO list, you could use
16053 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16056 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16057 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16058 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16059 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16062 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16063 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16067 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16070 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16071 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16072 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16073 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16074 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16079 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16080 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16082 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16083 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16084 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16085 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16089 category @r{The category of the item}
16090 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16091 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16092 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16093 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16094 diary @r{imported from diary}
16095 deadline @r{a deadline}
16096 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16097 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16098 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16099 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16100 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16101 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16102 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16103 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16104 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16105 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16106 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16107 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16108 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16112 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16113 led to the selection of the item.
16115 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16116 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16117 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16122 # define the Emacs command to run
16123 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16125 # run it and capture the output
16126 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16128 # loop over all lines
16129 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16130 # get the individual values
16131 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16132 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16133 # process and print
16134 print "[ ] $head\n";
16138 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16139 @section Using the property API
16140 @cindex API, for properties
16141 @cindex properties, API
16143 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16146 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16147 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16148 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16149 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16150 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16151 if the property key was used several times.@*
16152 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16153 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16154 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16156 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16157 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16158 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16159 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
16160 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16161 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16162 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16163 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16164 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16167 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16168 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16171 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16172 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16175 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16176 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16179 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16180 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16183 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16184 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
16185 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16188 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16189 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16190 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16193 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16194 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16195 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16198 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16199 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16200 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16203 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16204 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16205 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16208 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16209 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16210 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16211 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16212 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16213 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16214 responsible for this property.
16217 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16218 @section Using the mapping API
16219 @cindex API, for mapping
16220 @cindex mapping entries, API
16222 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16223 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16224 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16225 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16228 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16229 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16231 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16232 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16233 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16234 returned as a list.
16236 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16237 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16238 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16239 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16240 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16241 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16242 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16243 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16244 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16247 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16248 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16249 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16250 visited by the iteration.
16252 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16255 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16256 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16257 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16258 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16260 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16261 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16262 agenda-with-archives
16263 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16265 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16268 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16269 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16271 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16273 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16274 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16275 function or Lisp form
16276 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16277 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16278 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16279 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16283 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16284 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16285 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16286 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16288 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16289 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16290 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16293 @defun org-priority &optional action
16294 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16295 possible values for ACTION.
16298 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16299 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16300 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16304 Promote the current entry.
16308 Demote the current entry.
16311 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16312 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16313 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16317 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16318 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16321 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16322 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16325 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16328 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16329 @appendix MobileOrg
16333 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16334 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16335 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16336 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16337 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16338 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16339 Moreland. Android users should check out
16340 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16341 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16344 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16345 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16346 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16348 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16349 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16350 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16351 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16352 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16353 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16354 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16357 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16358 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16359 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16362 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16363 @section Setting up the staging area
16365 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16366 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16367 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16368 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16369 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16370 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16371 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16372 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16373 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16374 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16375 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16377 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16378 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16379 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16380 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16381 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16382 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16383 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16387 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16390 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16391 and to read captured notes from there.
16393 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16394 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16396 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16397 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16398 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16399 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16400 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16401 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16402 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16403 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16404 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16405 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16406 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16407 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16408 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16409 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16410 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16411 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16412 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
16413 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16415 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16416 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16418 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16419 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16420 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16421 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16422 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16426 Org moves all entries found in
16427 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16428 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16429 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16430 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16432 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16433 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16434 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16435 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16436 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16437 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16438 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16439 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16441 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16442 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16443 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16444 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16449 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16450 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16451 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16452 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16453 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16454 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16455 this flagged entry is finished.
16460 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16461 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16462 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16463 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16464 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16465 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16466 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16468 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16469 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16470 @cindex acknowledgments
16474 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16475 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16476 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16477 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16478 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16479 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16480 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16481 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16482 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16483 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16484 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16485 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16486 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16487 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16488 functionality directly into a notes file.
16490 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16491 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16492 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16493 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16494 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16495 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16496 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16499 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16502 @item Bastien Guerry
16503 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16504 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16505 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16506 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16507 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16508 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16509 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16510 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16511 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16512 programming and reproducible research.
16514 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16515 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16516 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16517 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16518 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16519 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16520 @item Sebastian Rose
16521 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16522 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16523 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16524 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16525 single-key navigation.
16528 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
16529 know what I am missing here!
16534 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16536 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16538 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16541 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16543 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16545 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16547 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16549 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16550 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16552 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16555 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16556 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16557 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16559 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16561 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16563 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16564 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16567 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16569 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16570 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16571 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16573 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16574 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16576 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16577 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16578 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16580 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16583 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16585 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16587 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16588 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16590 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16592 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16594 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16596 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16599 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16600 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16602 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16604 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16606 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16608 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16611 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16612 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16613 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16615 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16618 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16620 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16621 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16623 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16625 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16627 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16628 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16630 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16631 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16633 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16634 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16635 small fixes and patches.
16637 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16639 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16641 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16644 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16647 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16649 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16650 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16652 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16654 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16656 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16657 file links, and TAGS.
16659 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16660 version of the reference card.
16662 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16665 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16667 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16668 links, among other things.
16670 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16671 provided frequent feedback.
16673 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16674 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16676 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16678 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16681 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16682 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16684 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16686 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16687 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16689 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16692 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16693 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16695 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16698 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16700 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16701 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16703 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16704 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16706 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16707 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16709 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16712 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16714 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16715 tweaks and features.
16717 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16718 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16720 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16721 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16723 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16724 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16726 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16727 chapter about publishing.
16729 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16731 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16732 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16734 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16735 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16736 concept index for HTML export.
16738 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16741 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16743 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16746 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16749 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16752 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16755 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16756 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16761 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16762 @unnumbered Concept index
16766 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16767 @unnumbered Key index
16771 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16772 @unnumbered Command and function index
16776 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16777 @unnumbered Variable index
16779 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16780 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16781 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16787 @c Local variables:
16789 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16790 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16791 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16795 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre